Psion Teklogix 7525C User manual

Psion Teklogix 7525C User manual
WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held
Computer With
Windows Mobile 2003 SE
User Manual
May 4, 2005
ISO 9001 Certified
Quality Management System
Part No. 8100058.A
© Copyright 2005 by Psion Teklogix Inc., Mississauga, Ontario
This document and the information it contains is the property of Psion Teklogix Inc.,
is issued in strict confidence, and is not to be reproduced or copied, in whole or in
part, except for the sole purpose of promoting the sale of Teklogix manufactured
goods and services. Furthermore, this document is not to be used as a basis for
design, manufacture, or sub-contract, or in any manner detrimental to the interests
of Psion Teklogix Inc.
All trademarks are the property of their respective holders.
Return-To-Factory Warranty
Psion Teklogix provides a return to factory warranty on this product for a period of
twelve (12) months in accordance with the Statement of Limited Warranty and Limitation of Liability provided at www.psionteklogix.com/warranty. (If you are not
already a member of Teknet and you attempt to view this warranty, you will be asked
to register. As a member of Teknet, you’ll have access to helpful information about
your Psion Teklogix products at no charge to you.) In some regions, this warranty
may exceed this period. Please contact your local Psion Teklogix office for details.
For a list of offices, see Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices. The
warranty on Psion Teklogix manufactured equipment does not extend to any product
that has been tampered with, altered, or repaired by any person other than an
employee of an authorized Psion Teklogix service organization. See Psion Teklogix
terms and conditions of sale for full details.
Important:To ensure prompt warranty service in North America, please register
the serial number of this device to activate its warranty coverage by
contacting Psion Teklogix at 1-800-835-5644 ext. 209, or via web-link
[email protected] Failure to do so could affect Psion
Teklogix’ ability to effectively service, repair, or support this device.”
Service
When requesting service, please provide information concerning the nature of the
failure and the manner in which the equipment was used when the failure occurred.
Type, model, and serial number should also be provided. Before returning any products to Psion Teklogix, please call the Customer Services Group for a Return Authorization number.
Support Services
Psion Teklogix provides a complete range of product support services to its customers. For detailed information, please refer to Appendix A: Support Services And
Worldwide Offices. This section also provides information about accessing support
services through the Psion Teklogix web site.
Disclaimer
Every effort has been made to make this material complete, accurate, and up-to-date.
In addition, changes are periodically added to the information herein; these changes
will be incorporated into new editions of the publication.
Psion Teklogix Inc. reserves the right to make improvements and/or changes in the
product(s) and/or the program(s) described in this document without notice, and
shall not be responsible for any damages, including but not limited to consequential
damages, caused by reliance on the material presented, including but not limited to
typographical errors.
TABLE
Program License Agreements . .
Approvals And Safety Summary
OF CONTENTS
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .I
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IX
Chapter 1: Introduction
1.1
1.2
1.3
About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Text Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held Computer . .
1.3.1 Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.2 The WORKABOUT PRO C Hand-Held Computer .
1.3.3 The WORKABOUT PRO S Hand-Held Computer .
1.3.4 Regulatory Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 3
. 4
. 4
. 4
. 8
. 9
. 10
Preparing The WORKABOUT PRO For Operation . . . . .
2.1.1 The Main Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.2 Charging The Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.3 The Backup Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Turning The WORKABOUT PRO On and Off . . . . . . .
2.2.1 Installing The Battery And Switching The Unit On . .
2.2.2 Switching The Unit Off (Suspend). . . . . . . . . . .
The Companion CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Connecting The WORKABOUT PRO To A PC . . . . . . .
2.4.1 Using Microsoft® ActiveSync® To Work With Files
Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen . . . . . . . . . . .
Resetting The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 15
. 15
. 15
. 15
. 16
. 16
. 16
. 16
. 17
. 17
. 17
. 17
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
3.1
Features Of The WORKABOUT PRO C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
i
Contents
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
3.11
3.12
3.13
Features of the WORKABOUT PRO S . . . . . . . .
The Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.1 Battery Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.2 Removing And Installing The Battery Pack . .
3.3.3 Battery Swap Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.4 Charging The Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Switching The Hand-Held On And Off . . . . . . . .
The WORKABOUT PRO C Keyboard . . . . . . . .
3.5.1 Modifier Keys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.5.2 The Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.5.3 The Keypad Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The WORKABOUT PRO S Keyboard . . . . . . . .
3.6.1 Modifier Keys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.2 The Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.3 Accessing Alpha Characters . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.4 The Keypad Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.7.1 Adjusting The Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.7.2 Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen . . . .
Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.8.1 The LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.8.2 Audio Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time .
3.9.1 Storing Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Uploading Data In A Docking Station. . . . . . . . .
Bluetooth Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The SD/MMC Card—Adding Memory . . . . . . . .
3.12.1 Inserting The Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.13.1 Caring For The Touchscreen . . . . . . . . . .
3.13.2 Cleaning The WORKABOUT PRO . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
36
36
36
36
37
37
38
39
39
40
40
41
41
42
42
42
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
4.1
4.2
ii
Navigating In Windows Mobile 2003 SE And Applications . . . . . . 45
4.1.1 Navigating Using A Touchscreen And Stylus . . . . . . . . . . 45
Windows Mobile 2003 Desktop–Today Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Contents
4.2.1 Windows Mobile 2003 Navigation Bar . .
4.2.2 Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm. . . . . .
4.2.3 Ownership Information . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.4 E-mail Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.5 Task Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6 Calendar Of Upcoming Appointments. . .
4.3 Start Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.1 Customizing The Start Menu. . . . . . . .
4.4 New Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.1 Customizing The New Menu . . . . . . .
4.5 Managing Files And Folders . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.1 Creating A New Folder . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.2 Renaming A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.3 Copying A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.4 Deleting A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6 Using Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6.1 Menu Bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6.2 Pop-Up Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.7 The Taskbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.8 Programs–Using Applications . . . . . . . . . .
4.9 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.10 Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11 Entering Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.1 Soft Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.2 The Transcriber. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.3 Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 46
. 47
. 49
. 49
. 50
. 52
. 55
. 55
. 56
. 57
. 57
. 58
. 58
. 58
. 59
. 59
. 59
. 60
. 60
. 61
. 62
. 63
. 63
. 64
. 64
. 66
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 71
. 73
. 74
. 75
. 76
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
5.1
5.2
Installing The 802.11b Radio . . . . . . . . . . .
Connecting To A LAN Using An 802.11b Radio.
5.2.1 Entering New Settings . . . . . . . . . . .
5.2.2 Authentication Settings. . . . . . . . . . .
5.2.3 Deleting A Network . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 6: Settings
6.1
Personal Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
iii
Contents
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
6.8
6.9
6.10
6.11
6.12
6.13
6.14
6.15
6.16
iv
Buttons Icon . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.2.1 Up/Down Control . . . . . .
6.2.2 One Shots . . . . . . . . . .
6.2.3 Keyboard Macro Keys . . .
6.2.4 Unicode Mapping . . . . . .
6.2.5 Scancode Remapping . . . .
Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.1 Input Method Tab . . . . . .
6.3.2 Options–Additional Choices
Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.1 Start Menu Tab . . . . . . .
6.4.2 New Menu Tab . . . . . . .
Owner Information. . . . . . . . .
Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sound & Notifications . . . . . . .
6.7.1 Sounds . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.2 Notifications . . . . . . . .
Today Screen. . . . . . . . . . . .
6.8.1 Appearance . . . . . . . . .
6.8.2 Items . . . . . . . . . . . .
System Settings . . . . . . . . . .
About. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About Device . . . . . . . . . . .
Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.12.1 Battery Power . . . . . . . .
6.12.2 External Power . . . . . . .
6.12.3 Intensity . . . . . . . . . . .
Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.13.1 Choosing A Certificate . . .
Clock & Alarms . . . . . . . . . .
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.15.1 Main Tab . . . . . . . . . .
6.15.2 Storage Card . . . . . . . .
6.15.3 Running Programs . . . . .
Power Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.1 Battery Tab . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 81
. 82
. 82
. 84
. 85
. 87
. 89
. 89
. 94
. 94
. 94
. 95
. 95
. 96
. 96
. 96
. 97
. 97
. 97
. 98
. 98
. 99
. 99
. 99
. 100
. 100
. 101
. 101
. 103
. 103
. 103
. 103
. 104
. 104
. 105
. 105
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Contents
6.17
6.18
6.19
6.20
6.21
6.22
6.23
6.24
6.25
6.16.2 Wireless Tab . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.3 Advanced Tab . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.4 Battery Details . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.5 Card Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.6 Built-In Devices . . . . . . . . . .
Regional Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remove Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Screen Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Scanner Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1 Decoded (Internal) Scanners . . . .
6.20.2 Decoded (Intermec ISCP) . . . . .
6.20.3 Imager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.4 Options Tab . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.5 Translations Tab . . . . . . . . . .
Wireless WAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.1 Taskbar Icons. . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.2 Establishing A Connection . . . . .
6.21.3 Disconnecting From A Network . .
6.21.4 Advanced Information . . . . . . .
6.21.5 Tools Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Total Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.22.1 Creating A Backup Profile . . . . .
6.22.2 Restoring A Profile. . . . . . . . .
Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.23.1 Connecting To The Internet . . . .
6.23.2 Modem Connection Setup . . . . .
Setting Up A Network Card. . . . . . . .
6.24.1 Changing Network Card Settings .
6.24.2 VPN Connection Setup. . . . . . .
6.24.3 Managing An Existing Connection
6.24.4 Selecting A Network . . . . . . . .
6.24.5 Ending A Connection . . . . . . .
6.24.6 Proxy Server Setup . . . . . . . . .
6.24.7 Wireless Network Setup . . . . . .
Bluetooth Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25.1 Bluetooth Mode . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
105
106
107
107
108
108
109
109
110
111
128
132
138
140
141
141
143
144
144
146
154
155
157
158
158
159
164
165
166
167
169
170
170
171
172
172
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
v
Contents
6.25.2 Scanning For A New Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
6.25.3 The Bluetooth GPRS Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Chapter 7: Programs
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
7.7
7.8
vi
Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ActiveSync®. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.1 ActiveSync Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.2 Scheduling Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.3 Connecting To The Internet With ActiveSync . . . .
Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.1 Adding Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.2 Importing Contacts From Other Programs . . . . . .
7.5.3 Creating Contact Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.4 Assigning Contacts To Categories . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.5 Viewing Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
File Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Find . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.1 Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.2 Internet Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.3 Browsing Web Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.4 The View Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.5 Changing Security Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.6 Changing Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.7 Organizing Favorite Web Sites . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.8 Synchronizing A Favorite Link. . . . . . . . . . . .
Messaging–The Inbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.1 Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.2 Synchronizing E-mail With Outlook . . . . . . . . .
7.8.3 Changing Synchronization Settings . . . . . . . . .
7.8.4 Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
7.8.5 Downloading Messages From A Remote Server . . .
7.8.6 Replying And Forwarding Messages . . . . . . . . .
7.8.7 Receiving Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.8 Creating And Sending A Message . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 181
. 181
. 182
. 183
. 183
. 185
. 185
. 185
. 186
. 187
. 187
. 188
. 188
. 189
. 189
. 190
. 190
. 190
. 191
. 192
. 193
. 194
. 196
. 197
. 197
. 198
. 199
. 200
. 203
. 204
. 205
. 206
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Contents
7.8.9 Attaching A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.10 Deleting A Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.11 Storage Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9 MSN Messenger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.1 Setting Up Your MSN Account . . . . . . . .
7.9.2 Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.3 Signing In To MSN Messenger . . . . . . . .
7.9.4 Signing Out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.5 Adding Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.6 Deleting Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.7 Managing Your Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.1 Creating A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.2 Converting Notes To Text . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.3 Renaming A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.4 Recording Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.5 Synchronizing A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11 Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.1 Moving Photos To The WORKBOUT PRO. .
7.11.2 Opening A Photo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.3 Deleting A Photo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.4 Editing A Photo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.5 Creating A Slide Show . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.6 Pocket Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.7 Workbook Components . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.8 Moving Between Worksheets . . . . . . . . .
7.11.9 Adding, Deleting And Renaming Worksheets.
7.11.10Entering Data In A Worksheet . . . . . . . .
7.11.11Working With Cells, Rows and Columns. . .
7.11.12Creating Formulas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12 Pocket Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.1 Creating A New Document . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.2 Creating A New Document From A Template
7.12.3 Opening An Existing Document . . . . . . . .
7.12.4 Saving Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.5 Reverting To A Previously Saved Version . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
206
206
207
208
208
208
209
210
210
211
211
212
213
213
215
215
216
217
218
218
219
219
221
222
223
223
224
224
226
231
235
236
236
237
238
238
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
vii
Contents
7.12.6 Data Entry Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.7 Formatting Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.8 Sharing Documents With Your PC . . . . . . . . . . .
7.13 Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14 Terminal Services Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.1 Connecting To A Terminal Server . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.2 Moving Around Terminal Services Client . . . . . . .
7.14.3 Improving Display Performance . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.4 Improving Browser Performance . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.5 Disconnecting Without Ending A Session . . . . . . .
7.14.6 Ending A Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15 Windows Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.1 Converting A Media File On Your PC . . . . . . . . .
7.15.2 Copying Music Files From A CD . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.3 Copying Music And Video Files To Your Hand-Held .
7.15.4 Auto Syncing Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.5 Playing Music And Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.6 Windows Media Player Controls . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 239
. 241
. 245
. 245
. 245
. 245
. 246
. 246
. 247
. 247
. 247
. 247
. 247
. 251
. 253
. 253
. 255
. 258
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
8.1
Expansion Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8.1.1 Removing The End-Cap And Back Plate. .
8.1.2 What’s Inside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8.1.3 Shutting Off Power . . . . . . . . . . . . .
8.1.4 Installing The PC Card Expansion Module.
8.1.5 Installing A GSM/GPRS Module. . . . . .
8.1.6 Installing An SE 1223HP Scanner . . . . .
8.1.7 Installing An SE 923HP Scanner . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 261
. 261
. 262
. 263
. 263
. 265
. 268
. 269
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 273
. 273
. 275
. 276
. 279
. 280
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
9.1
9.2
Carrying Accessories . . . . . .
9.1.1 Attaching The Hand Strap
9.1.2 Attaching The Pistol Grip.
9.1.3 Protective Carrying Case .
9.1.4 Soft Shell Holster . . . . .
The Batteries . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
viii Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Contents
9.2.1 Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . .
Chargers And Docking Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.1 Installation–Chargers And Docking Stations . . . . . . . .
9.3.2 Power Consumption Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.3 Operator Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.3.4 Important Charger Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4 Desktop Docking Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4.1 Charging A Battery Installed In The WORKABOUT PRO .
9.4.2 Charging A Spare Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4.3 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4.4 Charger LED Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4.5 Troubleshooting The Charging Operation Of The Dock . .
9.4.6 Desktop Docking Station Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.4.7 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To A PC . . . . . . . . .
9.4.8 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To An Ethernet Network .
9.4.9 Troubleshooting The Docking Station Operations. . . . . .
9.5 Single Battery Charger–Model #WA3001 . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.5.1 Inserting A Battery In The Single Battery Charger . . . . .
9.5.2 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.5.3 Charge Indicators–The LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.6 Quad Battery Charger–Model #WA3004 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.6.1 Charging Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.6.2 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.6.3 Charge Indicators–The LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.6.4 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7 Quad Docking Station–Model #WA4004 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7.1 Quad Docking Station Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7.2 Quad Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7.3 Inserting A WORKABOUT In The Quad Docking Station .
9.7.4 Network Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7.5 Battery Charging–LED Behaviour. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.7.6 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.8 AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.9 Cigarette Lighter Adaptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10 The Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.1 Vehicle Cradle Mounting Recommendations . . . . . . . .
9.3
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
280
281
282
282
282
282
284
285
285
285
285
286
286
287
288
288
289
289
289
289
290
290
291
291
291
292
293
293
293
294
294
294
295
297
298
298
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
ix
Contents
9.10.2 Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.3 Using The Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.4 Maintaining The Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles
9.10.6 Powered Vehicle Cradle Installation . . . . . . . . . .
9.10.7 The Port Replicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
9.11 Bluetooth Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 299
. 299
. 300
. 300
. 301
. 302
. 302
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 307
. 309
. 309
. 309
. 310
. 311
. 312
. 313
. 313
. 314
. 316
Chapter 10: Specifications
10.1 Hand-Held Computer Specifications . . . . . . . .
10.2 Radio Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3 Scanner Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.1 SE 1223HP Scanner Specifications. . . . . .
10.3.2 SE 923HP Scanner Specifications . . . . . .
10.3.3 E1022 Linear 1D Imager Scanner . . . . . .
10.3.4 Symagery SX5390 Advanced Imager . . . .
10.4 Battery Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.1 Standard Battery Pack . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.2 High-Capacity Battery Pack . . . . . . . . .
10.4.3 Maxell ML2032 Rechargeable Coin Battery .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices
A.1 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-1
A.2 Product Repairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-1
A.3 Worldwide Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A-2
Appendix B: Port Pinouts
B.1
B.2
B.3
B.4
B.5
x
Standard Battery Contact Pin Definition . . .
High-Capacity Battery Contact Pin Definition
LIF (Low Insertion Force) Port Pinout . . . .
Tether Port Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio Mini-Plug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. B-1
. B-1
. B-2
. B-2
. B-3
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
PROGRAM LICENSE AGREEMENTS
EULA TERMS (WINDOWS MOBILE)
You have acquired a device ("DEVICE") that includes software licensed by Psion
Teklogix from an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation ("MS"). Those installed software products of MS origin, as well as associated media, printed materials, and
"online" or electronic documentation ("SOFTWARE") are protected by international intellectual property laws and treaties. The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold.
All rights reserved.
•
IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT
("EULA"), DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR COPY THE SOFTWARE.
INSTEAD, PROMPTLY CONTACT Psion Teklogix FOR INSTRUCTIONS
ON RETURN OF THE UNUSED DEVICE(S) FOR A REFUND. ANY USE
OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO USE ON THE
DEVICE, WILL CONSTITUTE YOUR AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA (OR
RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CONSENT).
•
SOFTWARE includes software already installed on the DEVICE ("DEVICE
Software") and MS software contained on the CD-ROM disk ("Companion
CD").
GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE. This EULA grants you the following license:
DEVICE Software. You may use the DEVICE Software as installed on the DEVICE.
Companion CD. A Companion CD is included with your DEVICE, and you may
install and use the Microsoft® ActiveSync® component on one (1) or more personal computers to exchange information with one (1) or more computing devices
that contain a compatible version of the Microsoft® Pocket PC Software 2003 operating system. For other software component(s) contained on the Companion CD,
you may install and use such components only in accordance with the terms of the
printed or online end user license agreement(s) provided with such component(s). In
the absence of an end user license agreement for particular component(s) of the
Companion CD, you may install and use only one (1) copy of such component(s) on
the DEVICE or a single personal computer with which you use the DEVICE.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
I
License Agreement
Phone Functionality. If the DEVICE SOFTWARE includes phone functionality, all
or certain portions of the SOFTWARE may be inoperable if you do not have and
maintain a service account with an appropriate Mobile Operator, or if the Mobile
Operator's network facilities are not operating or configured to operate with the
DEVICE.
Microsoft® Outlook® 2002. If Microsoft Outlook 2002 is included with your
Device, the following terms apply to your use of Microsoft Outlook 2002: (i)
regardless of the information contained in the "Software Installation and Use" section of the online EULA you may install one (1) copy of Microsoft Outlook 2002 on
one (1) personal computer to use, exchange data, share data, access and interact with
the DEVICE, and (ii) the EULA for Microsoft Outlook 2002 is between Psion Teklogix and the end user - not between the PC manufacturer and end user.
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS AND LIMITATIONS
II
•
Speech/Handwriting Recognition. If the DEVICE Software includes speech
and/or handwriting recognition component(s), you should understand that
speech and handwriting recognition are inherently statistical processes and that
errors can occur in the component's recognition of your handwriting, and the
final conversion into text. Neither Psion Teklogix nor its suppliers shall be
liable for any damages arising out of errors in the speech and handwriting recognition process.
•
Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation and Disassembly. You
may not reverse engineer, decompile, or disassemble the SOFTWARE, except
and only to the extent that such activity is expressly permitted by applicable law
notwithstanding this limitation.
•
Single DEVICE. The DEVICE Software is licensed with the DEVICE as a
single integrated product. The DEVICE Software installed in read only
memory ("ROM") of the DEVICE may only be used as part of the DEVICE.
•
Single EULA. The package for the DEVICE may contain multiple versions of
this EULA, such as multiple translations and/or multiple media versions (e.g.,
in the user documentation and in the software). Even if you receive multiple
versions of the EULA, you are licensed to use only one (1) copy of the
DEVICE Software.
•
NOTICE REGARDING THE MPEG-4 VISUAL STANDARD. The
DEVICE Software may include MPEG-4 visual decoding technology. MPEG
LA, L.L.C. requires the following notice:
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
License Agreement
•
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE IN ANY MANNER THAT COMPLIES
WITH THE MPEG 4 VISUAL STANDARD IS PROHIBITED, EXCEPT
FOR USE DIRECTLY RELATED TO (A) DATA OR INFORMATION (i)
GENERATED BY AND OBTAINED WITHOUT CHARGE FROM A
CONSUMER NOT THEREBY ENGAGED IN A BUSINESS ENTERPRISE, AND (ii) FOR PERSONAL USE ONLY; AND (B) OTHER USES
SPECIFICALLY AND SEPARATELY LICENSED BY MPEG LA, L.L.C.
If you have questions regarding this Notice, please contact MPEG LA,
L.L.C., 250 Steele Street, Suite 300, Denver, Colorado 80206; Telephone
303 331.1880; FAX 303 331.1879
•
Rental. You may not rent, lease or lend the DEVICE SOFTWARE.
•
SOFTWARE Transfer. You may permanently transfer all of your rights under
this EULA only as part of a sale or transfer of the DEVICE, provided you retain
no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE (including all component parts,
the media and printed materials, any upgrades, this EULA and, if applicable,
the Certificate(s) of Authenticity), and the recipient agrees to the terms of this
EULA. If the SOFTWARE is an upgrade, any transfer must include all prior
versions of the SOFTWARE.
If the DEVICE SOFTWARE includes phone functionality, you may not permanently transfer any of your rights under this EULA with regard to the DEVICE
Software or Companion CD, except as permitted by the applicable Mobile
Operator. In the event that the Mobile Operator permits such transfer, you may
permanently transfer all of your rights under this EULA only as part of a sale or
transfer of the DEVICE, provided you retain no copies, you transfer all of the
SOFTWARE (including all component parts, the media and printed materials,
any upgrades, this EULA and, if applicable, the Certificate(s) of Authenticity),
and the recipient agrees to the terms of this EULA. If the SOFTWARE is an
upgrade, any transfer must include all prior versions of the SOFTWARE.
•
Termination. Without prejudice to any other rights, Psion Teklogix or MS may
terminate this EULA if you fail to comply with the terms and conditions of this
EULA. In such event, you must destroy all copies of the SOFTWARE and all of
its component parts.
•
Security Updates/Digital Rights Management. Content providers are using
the digital rights management technology ("DRM") contained in your DEVICE
to protect the integrity of their content ("Secure Content") so that their intellectual property, including copyright, in such content is not misappropriated. PorPsion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
III
License Agreement
tions of the DEVICE Software and third party applications such as media
players use DRM to play Secure Content ("DRM Software"). If the DRM Software's security has been compromised, owners of Secure Content ("Secure
Content Owners") may request that MS block the ability of DRM license
servers and personal computers to deliver new licenses that enable an affected
DEVICE to play Secure Content. This action does not alter the DRM Software's ability to play unprotected content. A list of revoked DRM Software is
sent to your DEVICE whenever you download a license for Secure Content
from the Internet or from your personal computer. You therefore agree that MS
may, in conjunction with such license, also download revocation lists onto your
DEVICE on behalf of Secure Content Owners. MS will not retrieve any personally identifiable information, or any other information, from your DEVICE by
downloading such revocation lists.
IV
•
Consent to Use of Data. You agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or designated agent may collect and use technical information gathered in any manner as part of product support services related to the DEVICE
SOFTWARE. MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agents may use this information solely to improve their products or to
provide customized services or technologies to you. MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may disclose this information
to others, but not in a form that personally identifies you.
•
Internet Gaming/Update Features. If the DEVICE Software provides, and
you choose to utilize, the Internet gaming or update features within the
DEVICE Software, it is necessary to use certain computer system, hardware,
and software information to implement the features. By using these features,
you explicitly authorize MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their
designated agent to use this information solely to improve their products or to
provide customized services or technologies to you. MS or Microsoft Corporation and/or their designated agent may disclose this information to others, but
not in a form that personally identifies you.
•
Internet-Based Services Components. The DEVICE Software may contain
components that enable and facilitate the use of certain Internet-based services.
You acknowledge and agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates
and/or their designated agent may automatically check the version of the
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
License Agreement
DEVICE Software and/or its components that you are utilizing and may
provide upgrades or supplements to the DEVICE SOFTWARE that may be
automatically downloaded to your DEVICE.
•
Links to Third Party Sites. The DEVICE Software may provide you with the
ability to link to third party sites through the use of the DEVICE Software. The
third party sites are not under the control of MS, Microsoft Corporation, their
affiliates and/or their designated agent. Neither MS nor Microsoft Corporation
nor their affiliates nor their designated agent are responsible for (i) the contents
of any third party sites, any links contained in third party sites, or any changes
or updates to third party sites; or (ii) webcasting or any other form of transmission received from any third party sites. If the DEVICE Software provides links
to third party sites, those links are provided to you only as a convenience, and
the inclusion of any link does not imply an endorsement of the third party site
by MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent.
•
Additional Software/Services. The DEVICE Software may permit Psion Teklogix, MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent
to provide or make available to you SOFTWARE updates, upgrades, supplements, add-on components, or Internet-based services components of the
SOFTWARE after the date you obtain your initial copy of the SOFTWARE
("Supplemental Components").
•
If Psion Teklogix provides or makes available to you Supplemental Components and no other EULA terms are provided along with the Supplemental
Components, then the terms of this EULA shall apply.
•
If MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent
make available Supplemental Components, and no other EULA terms are
provided, then the terms of this EULA shall apply, except that the MS,
Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent entity
providing the Supplemental Component(s) shall be the licensor of the Supplemental Component(s).
•
Psion Teklogix, MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent reserve the right to discontinue any Internet-based services
provided to you or made available to you through the use of the DEVICE
Software.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
V
License Agreement
UPGRADES AND RECOVERY MEDIA.
•
DEVICE Software. If the DEVICE Software is provided by Psion Teklogix
separate from the DEVICE on media such as a ROM chip, CD ROM disk(s) or
via web download or other means, and is labeled "For Upgrade Purposes Only"
you may install one (1) copy of such DEVICE Software onto the DEVICE as a
replacement copy for the existing DEVICE Software, and use it in accordance
with this EULA, including any additional EULA terms accompanying the
upgrade DEVICE Software.
•
COMPANION CD. If any software component(s) is provided by Psion Teklogix separate from the DEVICE on CD ROM disk(s) or via web download or
other means, and labeled "For Upgrade Purposes Only", you may install and
use one (1) copy of such component(s) on the computer(s) you use to exchange
data with the DEVICE as a replacement copy for the existing Companion CD
component(s).
COPYRIGHT. All title and intellectual property rights in and to the SOFTWARE
(including but not limited to any images, photographs, animations, video,
audio, music, text and "applets," incorporated into the SOFTWARE), the
accompanying printed materials, and any copies of the SOFTWARE, are
owned by MS or its suppliers (including Microsoft Corporation). You may not
copy the printed materials accompanying the SOFTWARE. All title and intellectual property rights in and to the content which may be accessed through use
of the SOFTWARE is the property of the respective content owner and may be
protected by applicable copyright or other intellectual property laws and treaties. This EULA grants you no rights to use such content. All rights not specifically granted under this EULA are reserved by MS and its suppliers (including
Microsoft Corporation).
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS. You acknowledge that the SOFTWARE is subject to
U.S. and EU export jurisdiction. You agree to comply with all applicable international and national laws that apply to the SOFTWARE, including the U.S.
Export Administration Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use and destination restrictions issued by U.S. and other governments. For additional information, see http://www.microsoft.com/exporting/.
PRODUCT SUPPORT. Product support for the SOFTWARE is not provided by
MS, its parent corporation Microsoft Corporation, or their affiliates or subsidiaries. For product support, please refer to Psion Teklogix support number provided in the documentation for the DEVICE. Should you have any questions
VI
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
License Agreement
concerning this EULA, or if you desire to contact Psion Teklogix for any other
reason, please refer to the address provided in the documentation for the
DEVICE.
NO LIABILITY FOR CERTAIN DAMAGE. EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY
LAW, MICROSOFT CORPORATION AND THEIR AFFILIATES SHALL HAVE
NO LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR
INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING FROM OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THE SOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATION SHALL
APPLY EVEN IF ANY REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
FOR APPLICABLE LIMITED WARRANTIES AND SPECIAL
PROVISIONS PERTAINING TO YOUR PARTICULAR JURISDICTION,
PLEASE REFER TO YOUR WARRANTY BOOKLET INCLUDED WITH
THIS PACKAGE OR PROVIDED WITH THE SOFTWARE PRINTED
MATERIALS.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
VII
APPROVALS AND SAFETY SUMMARY
FCC DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (DoC)
Applicant’s Name & Address:
ASKEY COMPUTER CORP.
10F, NO. 119, ChienKang Rd., Chung-Ho,
Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C.
Contact Person: Piyang Chiang
Telephone No.: (510) 440-8694
47849 FREMONT BLVD. FREMONT,
CA, 94538, USA
US Representative’s Name & Address:
PSION TEKLOGIX
1810 Airport Exchange Blvd., Suite 500
Erlanger, KY, 41018, USA
Contact Person: Kyle Day
Telephone No.: (859) 372-4329
Equipment Type/Environment:
Computing Devices
Trade Name / Model No.:
WORKABOUT PRO, Model 7525
Year of Manufacture:
2004
Standard(s) to which Conformity is Declared:
The WORKABOUT PRO, model 7525, supplied by Askey Computer Corp., has been
tested and found to comply with FCC PART 15, SUBPART B - UNINTENTIONAL
RADIATORS, CLASS B COMPUTING DEVICES FOR HOME & OFFICE USE.
I, the undersigned, hereby declare that the equipment as tested is representative within
manufacturing tolerance to units.
Applicant
Legal Representative in U.S.
Signature
Piyang Chiang
Kyle Day
Full Name
Full Name
General Manager
V.P. Channel Sales
Position
Position
Askey International Corp
Erlanger, KY 41018, USA
Place
Place
Feb. 4, 2004
Feb. 4, 2004
Date
Date
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
IX
Approvals And Safety Summary
CE Marking
When used in a residential, commercial or light industrial environment the product
and its approved UK and European peripherals fulfil all requirements for CE marking.
R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC
This equipment complies with the essential requirements of EU Directive
1999/5/EC (Declaration available: www.psionteklogix.com).
Cet équipement est conforme aux principales caractéristiques définies dans la Directive européenne RTTE 1999/5/CE. (Déclaration disponible sur le site:
www.psionteklogix.com).
Die Geräte erfüllen die grundlegenden Anforderungen der RTTE-Richtlinie
(1999/5/EG). (Den Wortlaut der Richtlinie finden Sie unter:
www.psionteklogix.com).
Questa apparecchiatura è conforme ai requisiti essenziali della Direttiva Europea
R&TTE 1999/5/CE. (Dichiarazione disponibile sul sito: www.psionteklogix.com).
Este equipo cumple los requisitos principales de la Directiva 1995/5/CE de la UE,
“Equipos de Terminales de Radio y Telecomu-nicaciones”. (Declaración disponible
en: www.psionteklogix.com).
Este equipamento cumpre os requisitos essenciais da Directiva 1999/5/CE do Parlamento Europeu e do Conselho (Directiva RTT). (Declaração disponível no
endereço: www.psionteklogix.com).
Ο εξοπλισμός αυτός πληροί τις βασικές απαιτήσεις της κοινοτικής οδηγίας EU
R&TTE 1999/5/EΚ. (Η δήλωση συμμόρφωσης διατίθεται στη διεύθυνση:
www.psionteklogix.com)
Deze apparatuur voldoet aan de noodzakelijke vereisten van EU-richtlijn betreffende radioapparatuur en telecommunicatie-eindappa-ratuur 199/5/EG. (verklaring
beschikbaar: www.psionteklogix.com).
Dette udstyr opfylder de Væsentlige krav i EU's direktiv 1999/5/EC om Radio- og
teleterminaludstyr. (Erklæring findes på: www.psionteklogix.com).
Dette utstyret er i overensstemmelse med hovedkravene i R&TTE-direktivet
(1999/5/EC) fra EU. (Erklæring finnes på: www.psionteklogix.com).
X
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Approvals And Safety Summary
Utrustningen uppfyller kraven för EU-direktivet 1999/5/EC om ansluten teleutrustning och ömsesidigt erkännande av utrustningens överensstämmelse (R&TTE).
(Förklaringen finns att läsa på: www.psionteklogix.com).
Tämä laite vastaa EU:n radio- ja telepäätelaitedirektiivin (EU R&TTE Directive
1999/5/EC) vaatimuksia. (Julkilausuma nähtävillä osoitteessa:
www.psionteklogix.com).
L Use of the 802.11b WORKABOUT PRO C & S in France:
Owing to French Government restrictions, the 802.11b WORKABOUT PRO
C & S is limited to indoor use. They may be used outdoors, on private property, only with prior authorization from the French Ministry of Defense.
For GSM/GPRS Users in North America:
Although the GSM/GPRS Expansion Module is a three band device only the 1900
(PCS) band is used in North America
FCC Information To Users
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B
digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
XI
Approvals And Safety Summary
This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not
installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference
to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not
occur in a particular installation.
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception,
which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one of the following measures:
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to
which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician
for help.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)
this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
FCC Caution: Any changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
IMPORTANT NOTE:
FCC Radiation Exposure Statement:
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. End users must follow the specific operating instructions for
satisfying RF exposure compliance.
This device complies with FCC RF Exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled
environment, under 47 CFR 2.1093 paragraph (d)(2)
The equipment has been SAR-evaluated for use in PDA.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other
antenna or transmitter.
Some equipment in hospitals and aircraft are not shielded from radio frequency
energy. Do not use the WORKABOUT PRO onboard aircraft, or in hospitals,
without first obtaining permission.
Do not use near pacemakers. The product may affect the operation of some medically implanted devices such as pacemakers, causing them to malfunction. Avoid
placing your product next to such devices. Keep a minimum distance of 20 cm
XII
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Approvals And Safety Summary
between the device and the product to reduce the risk of interference. If you have
any reason to suspect that interference is taking place, turn off the WORKABOUT
PRO and contact your cardiologist for assistance.
Note: In August 1996 the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) of the US
adopted an updated safety standard for human exposure to radio frequency
energy emitted by FCC regulated transmitters. The design of this product
complies with the FCC guidelines and those standards.To maintain compliance with the FCC RF exposure guidelines, if you wear the Workabout Pro on
your body, use the supplied, or Psion Teklogix approve, carrying case. If you
do not use a body-worn accessory, ensure the antenna is at least 1.5 cm from
your body when transmitting.
Use of non-approved accessories may violate FCC RF exposure guidelines'
Emissions Information For Canada
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian InterferenceCausing Equipment Regulations. To prevent radio interference to the licensed service, this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from windows to
provide maximum shielding. Equipment (or its transmit antenna) that is installed
outdoors is subject to licensing.
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement
sur le matériel brouilleur du Canada. Afin d'éviter toute interférence radio avec le
service autorisé, l'appareil doit être utilisé à l'intérieur, tout en tant éloigné de toute
fenêtre afin de garantir le maximum de protection. Si cet équipement (ou son
antenne émettrice) est installé à l'extérieur, il est alors soumis à licence.
Warning to Users
Warning:Changes or modifications not expressly approved by Psion
Teklogix Inc. could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
This product complies with CDRH 21 CFR 1040 Class I/Class II and IEC 608251:1993+A1:1997+A2:2001 laser product.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
XIII
Approvals And Safety Summary
Important:
Waste Electrical and Electronic equipment (WEEE) directive
2003/96/EC.
This Product, and its accessories, comply with the requirements of the
Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) Directive 2002/96/EC.
If your end-of-life Psion Teklogix product or accessory was first placed on
the European Union market after August 12th, 2005, contact your local
country representative for details on how to arrange recycling.
For a list of international subsidiaries, please go to: www.psionteklogix.com.
LASER/LED WARNINGS
For your own safety, it is critical that you comply with the following warnings:
CAUTION
The laser/LED aperture is located in the front of terminal. Do not look into the
laser/LED beam or point the beam at people or animals.
CAUTION
Using controls or adjustments, or performing procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
CAUTION
The use of optical instruments with this product will increase eye hazard.
This product may contain a laser scanner that emits less than 1.4mW maximum
radiant power at a wavelength of 650nm or 680nm.
DO NOT OPERATE IN AN EXPLOSIVE ATMOSPHERE
Operating Psion Teklogix equipment where explosive gas is present may result in
an explosion.
DO NOT REMOVE COVERS OR OPEN ENCLOSURES
To avoid injury, the equipment covers and enclosures should only be removed by
qualified service personnel. Do not operate the equipment without the covers and
enclosures properly installed.
For qualified personnel: Remove the battery pack before removing the cover
and enclosures.
XIV Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Approvals And Safety Summary
CAUTION!
Danger of explosion if a battery is incorrectly handled, charged, disposed of or
replaced. Replace only with the same type recommended or sold by the manufacturer–i.e., Model WA3000 or Model WA3002. Dispose of used batteries according to the instructions listed under the heading “Lithium Ion Battery Safety
Precautions” on page 280. Carefully review all battery safety issues.
VORSICHT!
Explosiongefahr bei unsachgemäßem Austausch der Batterie Ersatz nur durch
denselben oder einen vom Hersteller empfohlenen gleichwertigen Typ.
Entsorgung gebrauchter Batterien nach Angaben des Herstellers.
CAUTION!
Use only Psion Teklogix approved power adaptors.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
XV
1
INTRODUCTION
1.1 About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1.2 Text Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
1.3 About The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held Computer .
1.3.1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1.3.2 The WORKABOUT PRO C Hand-Held Computer.
1.3.3 The WORKABOUT PRO S Hand-Held Computer .
1.3.4 Regulatory Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . .4
. . . . . . . 4
. . . . . . . 8
. . . . . . . 9
. . . . . . . 10
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
1
Chapter 1: Introduction
About This Manual
1.1 About This Manual
This manual describes how to configure, operate and maintain the WORKABOUT
PRO hand-held computer.
Chapter 1: Introduction
provides a basic overview of the WORKABOUT PRO hand-held.
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
describes the steps required to get the unit ready for operation.
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
describes the features and outlines how to charge and maintain the battery. This
chapter also provides information about indicators, SD/MMC card installation and
general maintenance.
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
describes the Microsoft® Windows Mobile 2003 SE’s Today screen and how to use it. This
chapter also outlines basics like moving around a window, displaying menus, and so on.
Chapter 6: Settings
provides a description of the Windows Mobile 2003 SE Settings options and
how to use them.
Chapter 7: Programs
provides a description of the Windows Mobile 2003 SE Programs options and
how to use them.
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
describes how to insert and configure an 802.11b radio.
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
provides instructions about installing expansion modules–the PCMCIA
module, the GSM/GPRS module and the scanner module.
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
describes the peripherals and accessories available for your hand-held.
Chapter 10: Specifications
details radio, hand-held computer, scanner and battery specifications.
Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices
provides the helpdesk phone number at the Mississauga, Ontario, Canada office
and details the support services available. This appendix also lists worldwide
office addresses and phone numbers, along with web access information.
Appendix B: Port Pinouts
describes port pinouts.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
3
Chapter 1: Introduction
Text Conventions
1.2 Text Conventions
Note:
Notes highlight additional helpful information.
Important:
These statements provide particularly important instructions
or additional information that is critical to the operation of
the equipment.
Warning:
These statements provide critical information that may prevent
physical injury, equipment damage or data loss.
1.3 About The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held Computer
The WORKABOUT PRO is a ruggedized hand-held personal computer, running
the Microsoft® Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system. It is intended for use in
commercial and light industrial applications with a focus on real time wireless data
transactions. This hand-held is optimized for mobile computing applications and
third party expansion. Psion Teklogix offers two models of this hand-held that
operate with the Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system: WORKABOUT PRO
C and WORKABOUT PRO S. Any differences between the units are clearly
indicated in this manual.
1.3.1 Features
WORKABOUT PRO Models
•
•
4
WORKABOUT PRO C
- Colour touchscreen display
- 64 MB Flash
- 128 MB RAM
- Integrated Bluetooth
WORKABOUT PRO S
- Colour touchscreen display
- 64 MB Flash
- 128 MB RAM
- Integrated Bluetooth
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Features
Processor:
•
400 MHz Intel Xscale PXA255
Operating System:
•
Microsoft Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Programming Environment:
•
•
•
•
•
HTML, XML
Psion Teklogix Mobile Devices SDK
Windows Mobile 2003 Standard SDK
.NET Compact Framework
WORKABOUT PRO Hardware Development Kit
Wireless Communications:
•
•
•
Optional expansion modules for:
802.11b (via Compact Flash slot)
GSM/GPRS (via expansion interface)
CDMA/lxRTT (via expansion interface)
Integrated Bluetooth class II, version 1.1 16.4 ft or 5m range standard on
WORKABOUT PRO C and S
Note: WAN, 802.11b and Bluetooth are available simultaneously on
WORKABOUT PRO C and S models.
Application Software:
•
Pocket Internet Explorer
User Interface:
•
•
•
Colour Touchscreen Display
- 3.5” (8.9cm) diagonal, 1⁄
4 VGA, 240 x 320 transflective portrait mode
TFT
- 16-bit colour
- Adjustable backlight
- Sunlight readable for outdoor use
- High reliability LED backlight
Touchscreen (standard)
- Passive stylus or finger operation
Signature capture
Keyboards
- Alphanumeric (C models)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
5
Chapter 1: Introduction
Features
•
- Numeric (S model)
- Ergonomic ambidextrous one-hand operation
- Backlit, high durability hard-capped keys
Indicators and Controls
- Internal speaker with volume control
- LED indicating battery charge status
Bar Code Applications:
•
•
•
•
•
Optional 2D SX5390 Imager expansion module*
Optional 1D E1022 Imager expansion module*
Optional 1D SE 1223HP laser scanner expansion module*
Optional SE 923 laser scanner expansion module*
Optional field-upgradeable/replaceable pistol grip*
* Note: All are field upgradeable
Expansion Slots:
•
•
•
One SD/MMC memory card slot–user accessible
100 Pin High-Speed Expansion connector, accessible through end-cap or
back cover
Supports serial, USB, PCMCIA
Type II Compact Flash slot accessible through end-cap
Other Expansion Modules:
•
Type II PCMCIA slot–field upgradeable
External Ports:
•
•
USB 1.1 Host port on base of tethered USB devices (printers, etc.)
Low Insertion Force Docking Station Port with:
USB 1.1 device port
USB 1.1 Host port
Battery charging
Power Management:
•
•
•
6
Optional full-shift Standard Lithium-ion (3.7V, 1700 mAh)
Optional High-Capacity Lithium-ion (3.7V, 2350 mAh)
Also accepts standard consumer available AA Alkaline batteries (C models)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Features
•
•
•
•
•
Quick swap pack
Advanced Smart Battery w/ gas gauge
3 power source options: Runs off battery, AC or automotive power supplies
Built-in charger
Rechargeable, user replaceable, coin cell backup battery
Environmental (Standard):
•
•
•
•
•
Operating temp: 14ºF to 122ºF (-10ºC to +50ºC)
Storage temp: -13ºF to 140ºF (-25ºC to +60ºC)
Humidity: 5-95% RH non-condensing
Rain/Dust: IEC 529, classification IP54
Shock: Multiple 4 ft. (1.2m) drops to polished concrete
Power Accessories
•
•
•
•
•
•
AC power supply (charge and operate hand-held)
Cigarette lighter power supply (charge and operate hand-held)
1 slot battery charger
Quad battery charger
Desktop Docking Station (charges hand-held and spare battery)
Vehicle cradle with optional charge capability
Communication Accessories:
•
•
•
•
Quad Dock (4-site) with 10/100BaseT Ethernet and charge functions
Desktop Docking Station (charges hand-held and spare battery) provides
USB host and device ports and supports optional 10/100 Base T Ethernet
module
Powered/non-powered cradle for vehicle applications
Port Replicator for vehicle cradles (field installable option) includes 3
RS232 ports plus USB device port.
Carrying Accessories:
•
Handstrap, pistol grip with trigger, holster, belt loop, protective vinyl carrying case (with optional shoulder strap).
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
7
Chapter 1: Introduction
The WORKABOUT PRO C Hand-Held Computer
1.3.2 The WORKABOUT PRO C Hand-Held Computer
Figure 1.1 WORKABOUT PRO C
Audio Jack
Tether Port
Low Insertion
Force Port (LIF)
Figure 1.2 Tether Port, Low Insertion Force (LIF) Port And Audio Jack
8
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
The WORKABOUT PRO S Hand-Held Computer
1.3.3 The WORKABOUT PRO S Hand-Held Computer
Figure 1.3 WORKABOUT PRO S
Audio Jack
Tether Port
Low Insertion
Force Port (LIF)
Figure 1.4 Tether Port, Low Insertion Force (LIF) Port And Audio Jack
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
9
Chapter 1: Introduction
Regulatory Labels
1.3.4 Regulatory Labels
Warning:
Using controls or adjustments or performing procedures other than
those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
Figure 1.5 Scanner Module–Laser Warning Label
Figure 1.6 End-Cap–Expansion Module Warning
Figure 1.7 Back Plate–Expansion Module Warning Label
Figure 1.8 Manufacturer Label–WORKABOUT PRO C Unit
10
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 1: Introduction
Regulatory Labels
Figure 1.9 FCC Compliance Label
Figure 1.10 Standard Capacity Battery Label
Figure 1.11 High-Capacity Battery Label
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
11
2
BASIC CHECKOUT
2.1 Preparing The WORKABOUT PRO For Operation . . . .
2.1.1 The Main Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.2 Charging The Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.1.3 The Backup Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2 Turning The WORKABOUT PRO On and Off. . . . . . .
2.2.1 Installing The Battery And Switching The Unit On .
2.2.2 Switching The Unit Off (Suspend) . . . . . . . . . .
2.3 The Companion CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.4 Connecting The WORKABOUT PRO To A PC . . . . . .
2.4.1 Using Microsoft® ActiveSync® To Work With Files
2.5 Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen . . . . . . . . . .
2.6 Resetting The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
15
15
15
15
16
16
16
16
17
17
17
17
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
13
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
Preparing The WORKABOUT PRO For Operation
2.1 Preparing The WORKABOUT PRO For Operation
2.1.1 The Main Battery
The WORKABOUT PRO C can be powered with one of the following batteries:
• Standard Battery
• High-Capacity Battery, or
• 3 AA alkaline batteries.
The WORKABOUT PRO S can be powered with one of the following battery packs:
• Standard Battery, or
• High-Capacity Battery
2.1.2 Charging The Battery
Important:
It is critical that you review the battery safety guidelines in “Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions” on page 280 before charging
the battery.
Battery packs shipped from the factory are charged to approximately 40%. They
must be fully charged prior to use.
Batteries can be charged using a variety of chargers and docking stations along with
a WORKABOUT PRO internal charger. When using the internal charger, a suitable
power source is required. All chargers and docking stations are described in
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories beginning on page 271.
2.1.3 The Backup Battery
To preserve data stored in your WORKABOUT PRO while you swap the main
battery, the unit is equipped with an internal backup battery–a standard Lithium
Alloy Manganese Dioxide coin battery–a Maxell ML2032.
The backup battery is trickle charged from the main battery pack and has a limited life
span. To maximize the life of the backup battery, avoid excessive discharging and
recharging of the backup battery by keeping the main battery fully charged. The
backup battery is not user-replaceable. If the backup battery requires replacement, the
WORKABOUT PRO must be returned to a Psion Teklogix approved service centre.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
15
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
Turning The WORKABOUT PRO On and Off
Important:
If you are powering up a new unit, a warning message may
appear on the screen indicating that the backup battery capacity is
low. To recharge the internal battery, you must fully charge the
WORKABOUT PRO with the main battery installed in the unit.
An overnight charge is recommended.
2.2 Turning The WORKABOUT PRO On and Off
2.2.1 Installing The Battery And Switching The Unit On
•
•
Note:
Turn the fasteners at the base of the battery cover counter-clockwise to
unlock the cover and remove it. The top of the stylus is slot-shaped to help
you loosen the fasteners.
Slide the charged battery into the unit. Replace the battery cover, and turn the
fasteners at the base of the battery cover clockwise to lock the battery in place.
If you are using a docking station or an external power supply, you can
insert an uncharged battery, dock the unit and switch it on.
To switch on the WORKABOUT PRO:
• Press and hold down the <ENTER/ON> key for at least one second.
• When the LED flashes green, release the <ENTER/ON> button.
The desktop Today screen is displayed.
Note:
If the unit was already in use–the unit may be off (suspend state)–pressing <ENTER/ON> ‘wakes’ the unit from this state. The screen in which
you were working prior to the suspend state is displayed.
2.2.2 Switching The Unit Off (Suspend)
•
Press the <BLUE> key, and then press <ENTER/ON> to switch off the
WORKABOUT PRO.
2.3 The Companion CD
Your WORKABOUT PRO is shipped with a Companion CD that runs automatically
when inserted, providing applications along with helpful information about your
hand-held and its operating system–Windows Mobile 2003 SE.
Note: If at any point while working with the CD, you are asked, “Do you want
to run or save this file”, do not to click the <Save> button.
Start Here–walks you through installing Outlook 2002 along with ActiveSync.
Before you begin the installation process, make certain that you carefully review
the installation notes.
16
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
Connecting The WORKABOUT PRO To A PC
Enhancing Your Experience–provides access to some additional applications that
you can install on your unit.
Learn More–provides access to the Windows Mobile web page and the
Psion Teklogix web page.
About This CD–provides copyright information about the CD.
Help–provides access to the main Microsoft web page and the Psion Teklogix
web page.
2.4 Connecting The WORKABOUT PRO To A PC
Note:
Refer to “Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To A PC” on page 287 for more
details about the desktop docking station and how to link to a PC.
The WORKABOUT PRO can be connected to a PC using the desktop docking station.
• Insert the unit in the desktop docking station.
• Use a Client USB connector to complete the communication link between
the hand-held and the PC.
2.4.1 Using Microsoft® ActiveSync® To Work With Files
ActiveSync®–Microsoft PC connectivity software–can be used to connect the
WORKABOUT PRO to PCs running this software. ActiveSync can be installed from
the Companion CD included with your WORKABOUT PRO.
By connecting the hand-held to a PC through your desktop docking station and
running ActiveSync on the PC, you can view WORKABOUT PRO files, drag and
drop files between the WORKABOUT PRO and the PC, connect to the Internet,
and so on.
2.5 Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen
Refer to “Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen” on page 36 for details.
2.6 Resetting The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held
Warm Reset
To execute a warm reset:
• Press and hold down the <BLUE> key and the <ENTER/ON> key simultaneously for a minimum of six seconds.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
17
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout
Resetting The WORKABOUT PRO Hand-Held
A warm reset closes open applications; any unsaved data are lost. Installed
programs and saved data are preserved.
Note:
You do not need to reset your WORKABOUT PRO after configuring the radio.
Cold Reset
Important:
A cold reset returns the WORKABOUT PRO to factory settings.
All data and settings are lost. Files and data stored in flash are
preserved.
There are two options when executing a cold reset: reset to BootLoader or reset
directly to Mobile 2003 SE operating system.
To execute a cold reset and access the BootLoader menu:
•
Press and hold down the left <SCAN> key, the <BLUE> key and the
<ENTER> key simultaneously for a minimum of six seconds.
After a cold reset, the BootLoader menu appears.
•
Type 1 to continue loading the Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system.
Once the operating system loads, a cab file containing utilities, drivers and software
updates is automatically installed, and the unit executes a warm start.
To execute a cold reset and launch the Mobile 2003 SE operating system
immediately:
•
18
Press and hold down the <BLUE>, <ORANGE> and <ENTER> keys for
minimum of 6 seconds.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
3
GETTING TO KNOW THE WORKABOUT PRO
3.1 Features Of The WORKABOUT PRO C . . . . . . .
3.2 Features of the WORKABOUT PRO S. . . . . . . .
3.3 The Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.1 Battery Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.2 Removing And Installing The Battery Pack . .
3.3.3 Battery Swap Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.3.4 Charging The Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.4 Switching The Hand-Held On And Off . . . . . . . .
3.5 The WORKABOUT PRO C Keyboard . . . . . . . .
3.5.1 Modifier Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.5.2 The Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.5.3 The Keypad Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.6 The WORKABOUT PRO S Keyboard . . . . . . . .
3.6.1 Modifier Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.2 The Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.3 Accessing Alpha Characters . . . . . . . . . .
3.6.4 The Keypad Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.7 The Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.7.1 Adjusting The Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.7.2 Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen . . . .
3.8 Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.8.1 The LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.8.2 Audio Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.9 Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time.
3.9.1 Storing Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.10 Uploading Data In A Docking Station. . . . . . . .
3.11 Bluetooth Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.12 The SD/MMC Card—Adding Memory . . . . . . .
3.12.1 Inserting The Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.13 General Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3.13.1 Caring For The Touchscreen . . . . . . . . .
3.13.2 Cleaning The WORKABOUT PRO . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
21
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
36
36
36
36
37
37
38
39
39
40
40
41
41
42
42
42
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
19
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Features Of The WORKABOUT PRO C
3.1 Features Of The WORKABOUT PRO C
Sound Port
Stylus
(pointing tool)
LED
(Light Emitting Diode)
Microphone
Figure 3.1 Front Of WORKABOUT PRO C
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
21
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Features Of The WORKABOUT PRO C
End Cap
Back Cover –
optional scanner
module fits here
Battery Cover
Battery Cover
Fasteners
Tether Port
Low Insertion
Force (LIF) Port
Audio Jack
Figure 3.2 Back Of WORKABOUT PRO
22
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Features of the WORKABOUT PRO S
3.2 Features of the WORKABOUT PRO S
Sound Port
Stylus
(pointing tool)
LED
(Light Emitting Diode)
Microphone
Figure 3.3 Front Of WORKABOUT PRO S
3.3 The Batteries
The WORKABOUT PRO C hand-held can operate with a Standard Lithium Ion
battery pack, a High Capacity Lithium Ion battery pack or three AA alkaline batteries.
The WORKABOUT PRO S can operate with either a Standard or a High Capacity
Lithium Ion battery pack; it does not support AA alkaline batteries.
If you are using a Lithium Ion battery pack, preparing the hand-held unit for operation requires that the battery pack be charged before it is installed in the unit.
To maintain data during a battery swap, the WORKABOUT PRO is also
equipped with a coin backup battery. Refer to “Battery Swap Time” on page 25
for additional information.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
23
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Battery Safety
3.3.1 Battery Safety
Important:
Before attempting to install, use or charge the battery pack, it is
critical that you review and follow the important safety guidelines
in the section entitled “Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions”
beginning on page 280.
3.3.2 Removing And Installing The Battery Pack
Removing The Battery Cover
•
•
Turn the fasteners at the base of the battery cover counter-clockwise to
unlock the cover. The top of the stylus has a screwdriver shaped end to help
you loosen the fasteners.
Lift and remove the cover.
Battery Cover Fasteners
Figure 3.4 The Battery Cover
Installing The Battery
•
•
Note:
24
Insert a charged battery in the unit.
Replace the battery cover, and turn the fasteners at the base of the battery
cover clockwise to lock the battery in place.
If you are using a docking station or other external power source,
you can insert an uncharged battery, dock the unit and switch it on.
Otherwise, always begin the day with a charged battery.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Battery Swap Time
3.3.3 Battery Swap Time
Assuming the default power saving parameters and battery reserve level have not
been altered, battery swap time is between 10 and 15 minutes—you will not lose
data if the battery is replaced within this time frame.
Keep in mind that user data is stored in a RAM-based folder by default—data in
these RAM folders is lost if the main and backup batteries are completely drained,
or if the unit is cold reset. The safest place to store data is in the \Storage (onboard
FFS) folder or on an SD or MMC memory card.
To protect against data loss, the unit will automatically shut down with enough
reserve in the main battery to last up to 72 hours.
3.3.4 Charging The Battery
Batteries shipped from the factory are charged to approximately 40% of capacity.
They must be fully charged prior to use.
Keep in mind also that, along with the main battery, the WORKABOUT PRO is
equipped with an internal, backup battery that preserves data stored on the unit
while the main battery is swapped.
Important: The backup battery is trickle charged from the main battery. To
maximize battery life, avoid excessive discharging and recharging
of the backup battery by keeping the main battery fully charged.
IF YOU ARE POWERING UP A NEW UNIT, a warning message
may appear on the screen indicating that the backup battery
capacity is low. To recharge the backup battery, you must fully
charge the WORKABOUT PRO with the main battery installed in
the unit. An overnight charge is recommended.
3.3.4.1
Important:
Chargers And Docking Stations
FOR DETAILED INFORMATION about chargers and docking
stations, refer to Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
beginning on page 280.
For battery safety, refer to “Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions” beginning on page 280.
Lithium Ion battery packs must be charged before use. These batteries can be
charged with a variety of chargers and docking stations. These include:
• Desktop Docking Station (Model #WA4002-1)—operates as both a charger
and a docking station. Operating as a charger, both the battery installed in
the hand-held and a spare battery can be charged simultaneously.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
25
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Switching The Hand-Held On And Off
•
•
•
Quad Docking Station (Model #WA4004)—can charge the battery of up to
four WORKABOUT PROs inserted in the docking station.
Single Battery Charger (Model #WA3001)—charges a single battery.
Quad Battery Charger (Model #WA3004)—charges up to four spare Standard or High-Capacity WORKABOUT PRO battery packs.
It can take up to 5 hours to charge a battery. The WORKABOUT PRO’s intelligent
charging system protects the battery from over-charging by terminating the charge
process when the battery is at maximum capacity.
Note:
Refer to “Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time” on page 39
for additional information about the battery.
Important:
To avoid damaging the battery, chargers will not begin the charge
process until the battery temperature is between 0° C to 45 °C
(32° F to 113° F).
3.4 Switching The Hand-Held On And Off
Switching On The WORKABOUT PRO
•
•
Press and hold down the <ENTER/ON> key for at least one second.
When the LED flashes green, release the <ENTER/ON> button.
The startup Today screen is displayed.
Note:
If the WORKABOUT PRO is in suspend state, pressing <ENTER/ON>
key ‘wakes’ the unit from this state. The screen in which you were working
before the computer entered suspend state is displayed.
Switching Off The WORKABOUT PRO (Suspend)
Important:
Keep in mind that turning off the WORKABOUT PRO does not
result in a complete reboot; rather, the unit enters a power-saving,
“suspend” state. When the unit is turned on from suspend state,
operation resumes within a few seconds.
To switch off the WORKABOUT PRO:
•
26
Press the <BLUE> key, and then press the <ENTER/ON> key.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The WORKABOUT PRO C Keyboard
3.5 The WORKABOUT PRO C Keyboard
Arrow
Keys
Scan
Key
Scan
Key
Display
Backlight Key
Contrast
Key
Orange
Key
Blue
Key
Figure 3.5 The Keys
WORKABOUT PRO C units are designed with a 55-key alphanumeric keyboard.
Along with the standard keyboard keys, these units are equipped with an
<ORANGE> and a <BLUE> modifier key to provide access to additional keys and
system functions. These functions are colour coded in orange and blue print above
the keyboard keys.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
27
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Modifier Keys
Note:
Almost all keys can be reprogrammed to suit your requirements.
3.5.1 Modifier Keys
The <SHIFT>, <CTRL>, <ALT>, <ORANGE> and <BLUE> keys are modifier
keys. Pressing a modifier key changes the function of the next key pressed. For
example, on a WORKABOUT PRO C, a square bracket is printed in orange print
above the <4> key. Pressing the <ORANGE> key followed by the <4> key displays
a square bracket rather than the number 4.
The <SHIFT>, <CTRL> and <ALT> keys operate like a desktop keyboard except
that they are not chorded (two keys held down simultaneously). The modifier key
must be pressed first followed by the key whose function you want modified.
3.5.1.1
Activating Modifier Keys
When a modifier key is pressed once, it is represented in the shift-state indicator
icon in the taskbar at the bottom of the screen. When the next key is pressed, the
modifier key becomes inactive, the shift-state indicator icon disappears from the
taskbar, and the soft keyboard icon is once again displayed.
Shift-state indicator icon replaces
softkey keyboard when a modifier
key is pressed.
Figure 3.6 Shift-State Indicator Icon
28
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Locking Modifier Keys
3.5.1.2
Note:
Locking Modifier Keys
The locking behaviour of the modifier keys can be changed so that, for
example, pressing any of these keys once will lock the keys ‘on’. Refer to
“One Shots” on page 82 for details. Note too that by default, the
<ORANGE> key is locked ‘on’ when pressed only once.
When a modifier key is pressed twice to lock it ‘on’, it will remain active until it is
pressed a third time to unlock or turn it off.
To help you identify when a modifier key is locked ‘on’, the key is represented in
the shift-state indicator icon with a black frame around it.
Figure 3.7 Shift-State Indicator Icon – Locked Modifier Key
Once a modifier key is unlocked, the shift-state indicator icon is replaced by the soft
keyboard icon in the taskbar.
3.5.2 The Keys
The <SHIFT> Key
The <SHIFT> key is used to display uppercase alpha characters and provide access
to the symbols above the numeric keys. Pressing this key twice locks it ‘on’ so that
when you press an alpha key, an upper case character is displayed. When you press
a numeric key, the associated symbol on the numeric key is displayed on the screen.
Pressing <BLUE> <SHIFT> allows the <SHIFT> key to act as a <CAPS> key, displaying uppercase characters.
The Arrow Keys
The Arrow keys are located on the grey, circular key at the top of the keyboard,
directly below the display. The arrow keys move the cursor around the screen–up,
down, left and right. The cursor is the flashing box or underline character that indicates where the next character you type will appear.
The <BKSP/DEL> Key
The <BKSP> key (sometimes referred to as destructive backspace) moves the
cursor one character to the left, erasing the incorrectly entered key stroke.
The <DEL> key (<BLUE> <BKSP>) erases the character at the cursor position.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
29
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The Keypad Backlight
The <CTRL> And <ALT> Keys
The <CTRL> and <ALT> keys modify the function of the next key pressed and are
application dependent.
The <TAB> Key
Typically, the <TAB> key moves the cursor to the next field to the right or downward.
The <ESC> Key
Generally, this key is used as a keyboard shortcut to close the current menu, dialog
box or activity and return to the previous one.
The <SPACE> Key
Pressing this key inserts a blank space between characters. In a Windows dialog
box, pressing the <SPACE> key enables or disables a checkbox.
The <SCAN> Keys
Pressing either of the <SCAN> keys–the two yellow keys situated in upper-left and
upper-right corner of the keyboard–activates the scanner beam. For units that do not
have internal scanners, these keys are inoperable.
The Function Keys–<F1> to <F10>
Function keys <F1> to <F10> perform special, custom-defined functions. These
keys are accessed by pressing <BLUE> followed by numeric keys <1> to <10>.
They can be used with the Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system or another
application.
The Macro Keys–<M1> to <M3>
Macro keys <M1> to <M3> contain up to 20 programmable characters (“positions”)
and executable keys. These keys are accessed by pressing <ORANGE> followed by
alpha keys <O>, <P> or <Q>. When pressed, the macro key executes a custom-defined string of characters, including executable keys.
3.5.3 The Keypad Backlight
The intensity of the keypad backlight and the conditions under which this backlight
is activated can be configured using the Backlight icon–tap on Start, Settings to
display this icon. Refer to “Backlight” on page 99 for details about this option.
30
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The WORKABOUT PRO S Keyboard
3.6 The WORKABOUT PRO S Keyboard
Scan Key
Scan Key
Arrow Keys
Scan Keys
Scan Key
FN/Blue Key
ALPHA/Orange
Key
Display
Backlight Key
Figure 3.8 WORKABOUT PRO S Keyboard
The WORKABOUT PRO S is equipped with a numeric keyboard. Along with standard keys, this unit is equipped with an <ORANGE> and a <BLUE> modifier key
to provide access to alpha keys along with additional keys and system functions.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
31
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Modifier Keys
Note:
Almost all keys can be reprogrammed to suit your requirements.
3.6.1 Modifier Keys
The <CTRL>, <ALT>, <ALPHA/ORANGE> and <FN/BLUE> keys are modifier
keys. Pressing a modifier key changes the function of the next key pressed. For
example, alpha keys are displayed in orange print above the numeric key <1>.
Pressing the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key followed by the <1> key displays the letter
a rather than the number 1.
The <CTRL> and <ALT> keys operate much like a desktop keyboard except that
they are not chorded—two keys cannot be held down simultaneously. The modifier
key must be pressed first followed by the key whose function you want modified.
Activating Modifier Keys
When a modifier key is pressed once, it is represented in the shift-state indicator
icon in the taskbar at the bottom of the screen. When the next key is pressed, the
modifier key becomes inactive, the shift-state indicator icon disappears from the
taskbar, and the soft keyboard icon is once again displayed.
Locking Modifier Keys
Note:
The locking behaviour of the modifier keys can be changed so that, for
example, pressing any of these keys once will lock the keys ‘on’. Refer to
“One Shots” on page 82 for details. Note too that by default, the
<ORANGE> key is locked ‘on’ when pressed only once.
When a modifier key is pressed twice to lock it ‘on’, it will remain active until it is
pressed a third time to unlock or turn it off.
To help you identify when a modifier key is locked ‘on’, the key is represented in
the shift-state indicator icon with a black frame around it.
Figure 3.9 Shift-State Indicator Icon – Locked Modifier Key
Once a modifier key is unlocked, the shift-state indicator icon is replaced by the soft
keyboard icon in the taskbar.
32
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The Keys
3.6.2 The Keys
The <ALPHA> Key
This key is used to access the alpha characters displayed in orange print above
numeric keys <1> through <9>.
The <Pg/Up> And <Pg/Dn> Keys
Pressing the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key followed by the <UP> or <DOWN> arrow
key activates the <Pg/Up> and <Pg/Dn> keys.
The <CAPS> Key
When this key is pressed, uppercase alpha characters are displayed. Press
<ALPHA/ORANGE> <.> to activate this key.
The Arrow Keys
The arrow keys contained in the round disk-shaped key at the top of the keyboard
moves the cursor around the screen—up, down, left and right.
The <BKSP/DEL> Key
This key moves the cursor one character to the left, erasing the incorrectly entered
key stroke. The <DEL> key (<FN/BLUE> <BKSP>) erases the character at the
cursor position.
The <CTRL> And <ALT> Key
These keys modify the function of the next key pressed—both are application
dependent.
The <TAB> Key
The <TAB> key usually moves the cursor to the next field to the right or downward.
Pressing <ALPHA/ORANGE> <TAB> move the cursor backward.
The <ESC> Key
Generally, this key is used as a keyboard shortcut to close the current menu, dialog
box or activity and return to the previous one.
The <SPACE> Key
Pressing the <SPACE> key inserts a blank space between characters. In a Windows
dialog box, the <SPACE> key enables or disables a checkbox. This key is accessed
by pressing <ALPHA/ORANGE> followed by the numeric key <0>.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
33
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Accessing Alpha Characters
The <SCAN> Keys
The WORKABOUT PRO S is equipped with five yellow <SCAN> keys. Two
<SCAN> keys are located on either side of the unit, next to the screen. Three additional <SCAN> keys are located near the top of the keyboard. Pressing a <SCAN>
key activates the scanner beam. For units without internal scanners, these keys are
inoperable.
The Function Keys—<F1> to <F10>
Perform special, custom-defined functions. These keys are accessed by pressing
<FN/BLUE> followed by numeric keys <1> to <0>. They can be used with the
Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system or another application.
3.6.3 Accessing Alpha Characters
All alpha characters are printed on the WORKABOUT PRO S plastic in orange
type above the numeric keys. To access an alpha character, you must first press the
<ALPHA/ORANGE> key and then press the numeric key above which the alpha
character you want to type is printed.
Because the alpha keys on this unit are laid out much like the letters on a telephone—generally in groups of three letters per numeric key—you need to take a
few extra steps to access the alphabetic characters. The examples following help
illustrate how to access alpha characters.
3.6.3.1
Choosing A Single Alpha Character
The examples following illustrate how to access, A, B and C, all of which are
printed in orange characters above the numeric key <2>.
Important:
The letters you choose appear in the taskbar, providing a visual
indicator of which letter will be displayed on the screen.
To choose the letter a:
•
Note:
34
Press the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key, and press the numeric key <2>.
To choose the second, third or fourth alpha character assigned to a
numeric key, you’ll need to lock the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key ‘on’. By
default, the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key is locked ‘on’ when pressed once.
However, depending on how your unit is set up in the One Shots tab, you
may find that you need to press the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key twice to lock
it ‘on’. Refer to “One Shots” on page 82 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Creating Uppercase Letters
To choose the second letter in the sequence—in this example, the letter b:
• Press the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key twice to lock it ‘on’. A shift-state indicator icon in the taskbar will represent the orange key with a black frame
around it to indicate that this key is locked ‘on’.
• Press numeric key <2> twice to display the letter b.
To choose the third letter in the sequence—in this example, the letter c:
• Press the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key twice to lock it ‘on’.
• Press numeric key <2> three times to display the letter c.
Note:
Keep in mind that there is a timeout if you pause for one second
between key presses when selecting the second, third or fourth letters
on a key. For example, suppose you want to type the letter ‘c’–you’d need
to press the <2> key three times. With the <ORANGE> key locked ‘on’, if
you press <2> twice and then pause between key presses for 1 second, the
letter ‘b’ will be selected automatically.
3.6.3.2
Creating Uppercase Letters
To display capital letters, you need to first activate the <CAPS> key. You’ll find this
key in orange print above the <.> (period) key.
•
Press <ALPHA/ORANGE> followed by the <.> (period) key to turn on the
<CAPS> key.
All alpha keys are displayed in uppercase until you press <ALPHA/ORANGE> <.>
again to switch the <CAPS> key off.
3.6.3.3
•
Choosing Multiple Alpha Characters
Press the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key twice to lock it ‘on’.
Each time you press a numeric key from <2> through <9>, an alpha character will
be displayed on the screen. Remember that you can refer to the taskbar for a visual
indication of which alpha key will be displayed on the screen.
Important:
Once you have finished typing alpha characters, remember to
turn off or unlock the <ALPHA/ORANGE> key. Check the
taskbar to make certain that the shift-state indicator icon (refer to
Figure 3.9 on page 32) is replaced by the soft keyboard icon.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
35
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The Keypad Backlight
3.6.4 The Keypad Backlight
The intensity of the keypad backlight can be configured using the Backlight icon
accessed by tapping on Start, Settings. Refer to “Backlight” on page 99 for details
about this option.
3.7 The Display
3.7.1 Adjusting The Backlight
The display backlight can be adjusted using the keyboard.
•
Press the Backlight key < > to cycle from the lightest to darkest settings,
and then back to lightest. Press <ORANGE> < > to cycle backward from
darker to lighter.
To set the backlight intensity and the duration of time that the backlight will remain on,
you’ll need to choose the Backlight icon. Tap on Start, Settings and then, tap on the
System tab. Refer to “Backlight” on page 99 for details about the Backlight icon.
3.7.2 Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen
If your touchscreen has never been aligned (calibrated) or if you find that the stylus
pointer is not accurate when you tap on an item, follow the steps below.
•
Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the System tab to display the Screen icon.
Figure 3.10 Screen Alignment Tab
36
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Indicators
•
Tap on the Screen icon to display the Alignment tab.
Figure 3.11 Alignment Screen
•
Tap on the Align Screen button, and follow the directions on the screen to
align (calibrate) the screen.
Note:
This window provides two additional tabs: ClearType and Text Size. Tapping on the ClearType tab allows you to enable the ClearType option to
smooth screen font appearance. The Text Size tab allows you to increase
or decrease the size of the font displayed on the screen.
3.8 Indicators
The WORKABOUT PRO uses an LED (Light Emitting Diode), onscreen messages
and audio tones to indicate the various conditions of the hand-held, the batteries, the
scans and so on.
3.8.1 The LED
A single, two-coloured LED is located on the left side of the unit, just above the
<BKSP> key. When you press <ENTER/ON>, the LED flashes green to indicate
that the unit has been powered up. The LED table below outlines the behaviour of
the LED while the unit is docked in a charger.
Keep in mind that the application running on the WORKABOUT PRO can dictate
how the LED operates. Review the documentation provided with your application to
determine LED behaviour.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
37
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Audio Indicators
If the unit is attached to an external power supply, the hand-held LED reflects the
battery charge status.
LED Behaviour
Charge Status
Solid Green
Charge complete.
Fast Blinking Green
Charge in progress. Battery charged to less than 80%
capacity.
Slow Blinking Green
Battery charged to greater than 80% of capacity.
Solid Red
Temperature outside charge range (0° C to 50° C).
Blinking Red
Battery is not charging. Battery fault.
Table 3.1 WORKABOUT PRO LED BEHAVIOUR
3.8.2 Audio Indicators
The audio speaker provides a variety of sounds when a key is pressed, a keyboard
character is rejected, scan input is accepted or rejected, an operator’s entry does not
match in a match field or the battery is low. To specify how you want your WORKABOUT PRO to respond under various conditions, refer to “Sound & Notifications” on page 96.
The volume keys are located above <A> and <B> on WORKABOUT PRO C
models and to the left and right of the arrow key on WORKABOUT PRO S models.
The increase volume key is labelled with a plus symbol
and the decrease
volume key is labelled with a minus symbol
.
3.8.2.1
•
•
3.8.2.2
•
•
38
Adjusting Speaker Volume On The WORKABOUT PRO C
Press the <BLUE> key twice to lock the key ‘on’ and then, press <A>—the
increase volume key
or <B>—the decrease volume
key until
the volume meets your requirements.
Remember to press the <BLUE> key again to turn it ‘off’.
Adjusting Speaker Volume On The WORKABOUT PRO S
Press the <FN/BLUE> key twice to lock the key ‘on’ and then, press the
<RIGHT> arrow key—the increase volume key
or the <LEFT>
arrow key—the decrease volume
key until the volume meets your
requirements.
Remember to press the <FN/BLUE> key again to turn it ‘off’.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time
3.9 Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time
Note:
When the main battery is at 50% capacity, a ‘low battery’ warning is displayed. When the battery is at approximately 10% capacity, a ‘very low
main battery’ notification bubble appears.
Under normal operating conditions, fully charged Standard Batteries hold a charge
for up to 8 hours. High-Capacity batteries can hold a charge for up to 12 hours.
As Lithium Ion batteries age, their capacity decreases gradually, and they are generally considered depleted after approximately 2 years of use (less than 60% of original capacity remaining). Keep in mind however that heavy usage or operating the
unit at temperature extremes will shorten the battery life.
Lithium Ion batteries do not require conditioning cycles and the WORKABOUT
PRO battery system (including chargers) requires no user interaction to maintain
peak performance.
To maximize the run time of your batteries, consider the following:
•
•
•
•
The display backlight is the largest drain on the battery. Try to keep its
brightness as low as possible.
The hand-held is ‘event’ driven—that is, when the unit is not in use, it
reverts to sleep mode (even when it appears to be running), saving battery
power. Events include a key press, touchscreen taps and scan triggers.
Power consumption is reduced if you avoid unnecessary events, and allow
the unit to sleep as much as possible.
The battery is a ‘smart battery’ with built-in intelligence.
Tapping on the Power icon under Start, Settings, System tab displays a
dialog box that provides detailed information about the battery status of the
main and backup batteries installed in your unit.
When the hand-held is switched off, it goes into a low-power, suspend state
but continues to draw a small amount of power from the battery. This
should not be an issue unless the unit is left in suspend state for more than a
week—for long-term storage, the battery should be removed from the unit.
3.9.1 Storing Batteries
Long term battery storage is not recommended. If storage is necessary:
• Always try to use a ‘first-in first-out’ approach to minimize storage time.
• Lithium Ion batteries age much faster at elevated temperatures. Store batteries at temperatures between 0° C and 20° C.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
39
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
Uploading Data In A Docking Station
•
•
•
Always charge batteries to at least 40 to 60% before storing them. Batteries
can be damaged by an over-discharge phenomenon that occurs when an
empty battery is stored for a long period of time such that the cell voltage
drops below a lower limit.
To minimize storage degradation, recharge stored batteries to 40 to 60%
every 4 or 6 months to prevent over-discharge damage.
A ‘never used’ Li-Ion battery that has been stored for 3 years may have
limited or no useful life remaining once put into service. Think of batteries
as perishable goods.
3.10 Uploading Data In A Docking Station
Important:
Review the documentation provided with the user application installed
in your WORKABOUT PRO before performing data uploads.
The desktop docking station and quad docking station allow the WORKABOUT
PRO to link to an Ethernet network. They are typically used to upload transaction
data to a server computer when a radio link is not available.
Note: Refer to “Chargers And Docking Stations” on page 281 for more details.
The desktop docking station can complete batch uploads to a Client USB connected
PC or server. An optional 10/100baseT Ethernet module is also available.
Unlike the desktop docking station, the quad docking station supports only TCP/IP
connections to a PC or server through a 10/100baseT Ethernet connection.
When a WORKABOUT PRO is properly inserted in a docking station, a dock icon
is displayed in the navigation bar at the top of the screen. The unit also detects the
presence of the Ethernet network.
3.11 Bluetooth Radio
Note:
Integrated Bluetooth class II radios are standard on WORKABOUT
PRO C and S units. Keep in mind also that Bluetooth is available simultaneously with WAN and 802.11b on a single unit.
The WORKABOUT PRO is equipped with an on-board Bluetooth radio. This type of
radio enables short range data communication between devices. The Bluetooth also
provides the capability to use a Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone as a data modem,
exchanging information with other Bluetooth devices and providing network access.
Refer to “The Bluetooth GPRS Phone” on page 175 for setup details.
40
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
The SD/MMC Card—Adding Memory
3.12 The SD/MMC Card—Adding Memory
To add additional non-volatile memory to your hand-held, you can insert a Secure
Digital/Multi-Media Card (SD/MMC) through the battery compartment.
3.12.1 Inserting The Card
•
Remove the battery cover and the battery.
A hinged door at the top of the battery compartment protects the connectors.
Hinged SD door
SD/MMC
Card
Figure 3.12 Inserting the SD/MMC Card
•
•
•
•
Lift the hinged SD door by gently pulling upward on the metal tab.
Orient the SD/MMC card according to the legend stamped into the battery
well plastic.
Place the card in the slot with the card contacts down, and slide it inward
until it latches into place.
Swing the hinged door back into place.
To remove the card:
• Gently press it inward slightly until the detent unlatches, and the card is
expelled from the slot.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
41
Chapter 3: Getting To Know The WORKABOUT PRO
General Maintenance
3.13 General Maintenance
3.13.1 Caring For The Touchscreen
The top of the touchscreen is a thin, flexible polyester plastic sheet with a conductive coating on the inside. The polyester can be permanently damaged by harsh
chemicals and is susceptible to abrasions and scratches. Using sharp objects on the
touchscreen can scratch or cut the plastic, or crack the internal conductive coating.
The chemicals listed below must not come into contact with the touchscreen:
•
•
•
•
sodium hydroxide,
concentrated caustic solutions,
benzyl alcohol, and
concentrated acids.
If the touchscreen is used in harsh environments, consider applying a disposable
screen protector (WA6110). These covers reduce the clarity of the display slightly
but will dramatically extend the useful life of the touchscreen. When they become
scratched and abraded, they are easily removed and replaced.
3.13.2 Cleaning The WORKABOUT PRO
Important:
•
•
•
42
Do not immerse the unit in water. Dampen a soft cloth with mild
detergent to wipe the unit clean.
Use only mild detergent or soapy water to clean the hand-held unit.
Avoid abrasive cleaners, solvents or strong chemicals for cleaning. The
plastic case is susceptible to harsh chemicals. The plastic is partially soluble
in oils, mineral spirits and gasoline. The plastic slowly decomposes in
strong alkaline solutions.
To clean ink marks from the keypad and touchscreen, use isopropyl
alcohol.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
4
WORKING WITH WINDOWS MOBILE 2003 SE
4.1 Navigating In Windows Mobile 2003 SE And Applications .
4.1.1 Navigating Using A Touchscreen And Stylus . . . . .
4.2 Windows Mobile 2003 Desktop–Today Screen. . . . . . . .
4.2.1 Windows Mobile 2003 Navigation Bar. . . . . . . . .
4.2.2 Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.3 Ownership Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.4 E-mail Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.5 Task Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6 Calendar Of Upcoming Appointments . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6.1 Creating And Editing Appointments . . . . .
4.2.6.2 Adding Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6.3 Using Categories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.2.6.4 Deleting Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3 Start Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.3.1 Customizing The Start Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4 New Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.4.1 Customizing The New Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5 Managing Files And Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.1 Creating A New Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.2 Renaming A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.3 Copying A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.5.4 Deleting A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6 Using Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6.1 Menu Bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.6.2 Pop-Up Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.7 The Taskbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.8 Programs–Using Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.9 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.10 Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11 Entering Text. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.1 Soft Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.2 The Transcriber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4.11.3 Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer. . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
45
45
45
46
47
49
49
50
52
53
53
54
54
55
55
56
57
57
58
58
58
59
59
59
60
60
61
62
63
63
64
64
66
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
43
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Navigating In Windows Mobile 2003 SE And Applications
4.1 Navigating In Windows Mobile 2003 SE And Applications
Graphic user interfaces like Windows Mobile 2003 SE for portable devices or
desktop Windows (2000, XP, etc.) utilize ‘point and click’ navigation. On the
WORKABOUT PRO, this is accomplished using a touchscreen and stylus rather
than a mouse.
4.1.1 Navigating Using A Touchscreen And Stylus
Note:
If the touchscreen is not registering your screen taps accurately, it may
need recalibration. Refer to “Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen”
on page 36.
A touchscreen is a standard feature on all WORKABOUT PROs. Each is equipped
with a stylus–a pointing tool that looks like a pen–stored in a slot at the top of the
unit. The stylus is used to select objects on the touchscreen.
•
Tap on the appropriate icon to open files and folders, launch applications
and programs, make selections, and so on.
4.2 Windows Mobile 2003 Desktop–Today Screen
Connectivity Indicator
Volume Control
Clock
Start Button
Today’s Date
Owner Information
E-mail Notification
Tasks To Complete
Calendar-Upcoming Appointments
Taskbar
Navigation Bar
Soft Keyboard
Figure 4.1 Windows Mobile 2003 Desktop
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
45
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Windows Mobile 2003 Navigation Bar
The Today screen displays all your important information–tasks, unread e-mails and
upcoming appointments–all in one place. The Start menu provides access to everything else you’ll need.
4.2.1 Windows Mobile 2003 Navigation Bar
The navigation bar along the top of the screen provides icons that, when tapped,
open their associated programs.
Volume Control
Start Button
Connectivity Indicator
Date & Time,
Battery Capacity &
Upcoming Appts.
Figure 4.2 Navigation Bar
Note:
When a peripheral is attached to the tether or LIF port of the WORKABOUT PRO, an associated icon is displayed briefly in the navigation
bar to indicate that the hand-held has recognized the connection.
Start Button
Tap on the Start button to display the Start menu.
Connectivity Indicator
The Connectivity Indicator icon provides a shortcut to the Connections tab in the
Settings window. This tab provides access to Bluetooth, network, network card and
internet connection setups.
Figure 4.3 Connectivity Shortcut
46
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm
Volume Control
Tapping on this icon displays a sliding tab that allows you to adjust the speaker
volume or turn the speaker on and off.
Figure 4.4 Volume Adjustment Shortcut
Clock
Tapping on this icon displays a bubble which indicates the current date and time. It
also indicates the power connection–either AC or battery. Finally, this icon lists any
upcoming appointments.
Figure 4.5 Time Shortcut
4.2.2 Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm
This option displays the current date. If you need to adjust the date or set an alarm:
• In the Today screen, tap on today’s date.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
47
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm
The Clock & Alarms screen is displayed.
Figure 4.6 Clock Screen
•
Tap on the drop-down menu arrows to set the GMT, time and date.
An option to set the date and time for a visiting time zone is also available.
To set an alarm:
• Tap on the Alarms tab.
Figure 4.7 Alarms Screen
You can set a maximum of three alarms.
•
•
48
Tap in the checkbox to enable an alarm.
Tap the day on which you want the alarm to go off–Sunday through Saturday.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Ownership Information
•
•
Tap on the clock and set the time of the alarm. Keep in mind that it can only
be set for hours–minutes cannot be specified.
Tap on OK to save your changes.
4.2.3 Ownership Information
This option allows you to add your personal information to the WORKABOUT
PRO. Some of this information will be displayed in the desktop Today screen.
•
Tap on Owner to display a screen in which you can type information.
•
Type your name, company name, address, telephone number and
e-mail address.
You can type information using the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard, or you
can tap on the soft keyboard icon in the bottom right corner of the taskbar
to display an onscreen keyboard.
Figure 4.8 Ownership Information Screen
Note:
The Ownership screen has two additional tabs–Notes where you can add any pertinent, additional information and Options where you can specify whether you want
the desktop to display your ‘identification’ information or your ‘note’ information.
4.2.4 E-mail Notification
If you have any e-mail, it will be indicated in the Today desktop screen. To view
your e-mail, tap on the E-mail Notification option.
Refer to “Messaging–The Inbox” on page 197 for details about setting up your
Inbox. To synchronize this option with your PC, refer to “Synchronizing E-mail
With Outlook” on page 198.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
49
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Task Notification
4.2.5 Task Notification
Tasks lets you create lists of entries representing your responsibilities, upcoming
projects, and so on. If you’ve assigned any tasks, this option lets you know how
many active tasks you have.
Note:
•
You can synchronize the Task Notification option using ActiveSync so that
any tasks are displayed on your WORKABOUT PRO as well as your PC.
Refer to “ActiveSync Options” on page 182 for details.
Tap on the Tasks option to display a list of tasks.
Figure 4.9 Viewing And Creating Tasks
Creating A Task
•
•
•
50
Tap in the Tap here to add a new task field. The text is replaced with a
blinking cursor, and the soft (onscreen) keyboard appears.
Tap the stylus on the soft keyboard, or use the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard to type your task description.
Tap anywhere in the blank part of the screen, or press <ENTER> to add the
task to your list.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Task Notification
Editing A Task
•
Tap on a task in the task list to select it, and then tap the Edit menu to
display a detailed task screen where you can define task characteristics.
Figure 4.10 Task Details Screen
Each of the nine items in this screen, when tapped, displays a drop-down menu
where you can choose from a list of options, or you can type the text directly using
either the soft keyboard or the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard.
•
Note:
Once you’ve completed all the appropriate fields, tap on OK to save your
changes.
You can also tap on the Notes tab to add additional information about the
task your are defining.
Deleting A Task
•
•
Press and hold the stylus on a task until a pop-up menu is displayed.
Tap on Delete Task.
Marking A Task As Completed
•
In the Tasks list, tap the checkbox next to the items that are completed.
Sorting Tasks
•
Tap on the drop-down menu in the upper right-hand part of the screen.
You can choose from Status, Priority, Subject, Start Date or Due Date. The tasks
are arranged in the list according to the criterion you chose.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
51
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Calendar Of Upcoming Appointments
Limiting The Tasks Displayed In The Task Screen
•
Tap on the drop-down list in the upper left-hand corner of the screen.
You can choose Recent, All Tasks, No Categories, Active Tasks, or Completed
Tasks. The tasks are displayed in the screen according to the preference you chose.
4.2.6 Calendar Of Upcoming Appointments
This option is used to map out all your upcoming appointments, meetings and so on
in the weeks, months and even years ahead.
Note:
You can synchronize the Calendar using ActiveSync so that any meetings,
appointments and so on are displayed on your WORKABOUT PRO Today
screen as well as on your PC. Refer to “ActiveSync Options” on page 182
for details.
•
Tap on the Calendar option in the Today screen, or tap on Start, Calendar
to display the calendar.
Figure 4.11 Calendar
In the taskbar at the bottom of the calendar, a number of icons allow you to view
your calendar in one of five ways depending on which icon you choose. These
include the Today icon
to view today’s agenda, the Day icon
to view
today’s hourly schedule, the Week icon
to view the entire week’s schedule and
the Month
and Year
icons to view the month’s and year’s schedule,
respectively.
52
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Creating And Editing Appointments
4.2.6.1
•
Creating And Editing Appointments
In the Calendar screen, tap the New menu.
Figure 4.12 Appointment Detail Screen
•
•
In the Subject field, name the appointment.
Type additional information about the appointment in the other fields provided.
Note:
Refer to “Adding Reminders” on page 53 for details about reminders.
Refer to “Using Categories” on page 54 for information about this option.
•
4.2.6.2
•
Tap on OK to save your changes and close the screen.
Adding Reminders
Tap an appointment to display it in a Summary screen, and tap the Edit menu.
Figure 4.13 Appointment Details Screen
If you want to be reminded in advance of an appointment:
• In the first Reminder field, choose Remind me from the drop-down menu.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
53
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Using Categories
•
•
•
4.2.6.3
In the second Reminder field, tap on the number in the field to display a
drop-down menu where you can define a numeric value of 1, 5, 10, 15, 30.
Tap on minute(s) to display a drop-down menu from which you can choose
the time unit for your reminder–minute(s), hour(s), day(s) or week(s).
Tap OK to finish. You are returned to the view you were in before adding
the reminder.
Tap the appointment in the Calendar screen to display it in a summary
screen. The reminder is indicated by the small, ringing bell icon.
Using Categories
Categories help you organize and track the different kinds of data you keep on your
hand-held.
To assign an appointment to a category:
• Tap on an appointment to display it in its Summary screen, and tap on the
Edit menu. The Appointment Details screen is displayed. (Refer to
Figure 4.13 on page 53 to view a sample screen.)
• If necessary, use the scroll bar to display the Categories field.
• Tap the Categories field to display the Categories screen.
Figure 4.14 Categories Screen
•
•
4.2.6.4
•
•
54
Tap in the checkbox next to the category to which you want to assign the
appointment.
Tap OK. Your appointment is assigned to the category or categories you chose.
Deleting Appointments
Press and hold the stylus on the appointment you want to delete.
Tap on Delete Appointment in the pop-up menu.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Start Menu
4.3 Start Menu
To display the Start menu:
• Tap on the Start button in the upper-left corner of the Windows Mobile 2003
SE navigation bar.
Start Button
Navigation Bar
7 custom-chosen
programs
5 most recently used
programs
Windows Mobile
command centre
Figure 4.15 Start Menu
•
Tap on the Start menu item with which you want to work.
4.3.1 Customizing The Start Menu
You can choose the items you want to appear in the Start menu–items you use most often.
•
Tap on Start, Settings.
Figure 4.16 Personal Settings Screen
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
55
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
New Menu
•
In the Personal tab, tap on the Menus icon.
•
Tap the stylus in the checkboxes next to the items you want to appear in
your Start menu. When you’ve finished your selections, tap on OK.
Figure 4.17 Menus Screen
Note:
Keep in mind that you are limited to a maximum of 7 programs choices at
one time.
4.4 New Menu
The New menu provides quick access to a number of options such as tasks, contacts,
along with some applications. To display the New menu:
•
Tap on New in the taskbar at the bottom of the Today screen.
Figure 4.18 New Menu
56
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Customizing The New Menu
4.4.1 Customizing The New Menu
To choose from a list of possible items to be displayed in the New menu:
•
Tap on Start, Settings followed by the Menus icon. Tap on the New Menu tab.
Figure 4.19 New Menu Tab
•
Tap in the checkbox next to the items you want listed in the New menu.
Checkmarked items will be displayed in the New menu.
4.5 Managing Files And Folders
Windows Mobile 2003 SE files are stored in folders and sub-folders that are accessible with File Explorer. You can open, save, rename, copy and paste files in the same
manner as you would on any desktop PC.
•
Tap on Start, File Explorer.
If this option is not available in the Start menu, tap on Start, Programs.
Tap on the File Explorer icon.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
57
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Creating A New Folder
Documents are automatically
stored here.
Tap on a folder to
open it
Menus contain
application-specific
commands
Soft keyboard
Internal file storage
Storage card
Shared network files
Figure 4.20 File Explorer Screen.
4.5.1 Creating A New Folder
•
•
•
•
Tap Start, File Explorer.
Tap Edit in the menu bar.
Tap New Folder.
Use the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard or the soft keyboard to assign a
name to the folder.
4.5.2 Renaming A File
•
•
Press and hold the stylus on the file you want to rename. A ring of dots is
displayed followed by a pop-up menu.
Tap Rename. The file name is highlighted. Type a new name.
4.5.3 Copying A File
•
•
•
58
Press and hold the stylus on the file you want to copy. A ring of dots is displayed followed by a pop-up menu.
Tap on Copy in the pop-up menu.
Navigate to the location where you want to copy the file.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Deleting A File
•
•
Press and hold the stylus in a blank area of the screen—away from other
icons—until a pop-up menu is displayed.
Tap Paste to copy the file to the new location.
4.5.4 Deleting A File
•
•
Press and hold the stylus on the file or folder you want to delete until a
pop-up menu is displayed.
Tap Delete to remove the file.
4.6 Using Menus
Menus in Windows Mobile 2003 SE differ slightly from your desktop PC in minor
ways–they differ in the location of menus and the number of options available in
each menu.
Menu Bar
Figure 4.21 Menu Bar
The menu bar in the Windows Mobile 2003 SE appears at the bottom rather than at
the top of a program screen.
4.6.1 Menu Bars
To execute a command available in the menu bar:
•
•
Tap on a menu to display the commands associated with it.
Tap on the command you want to execute.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
59
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Pop-Up Menus
4.6.2 Pop-Up Menus
Pop-up menus are available in many screens and programs. They offer quick access
to a group of useful commands in addition to those available in the menu bar. To
display a pop-up menu:
•
Gently press and hold the stylus on the screen. A ring of dots is displayed
on the screen followed by a pop-up menu.
Figure 4.22 Pop-Up Menu
•
Tap on the command you want to execute.
4.7 The Taskbar
Taskbar
Soft keyboard
Menu
Figure 4.23 The Taskbar
60
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Programs–Using Applications
The WORKABOUT PRO is equipped with a taskbar at the bottom of the screen. It
displays menus and an icon representing the soft keyboard.
The taskbar also displays active modifier keys–<SHIFT>, <ALT>, <CTRL>,
<ORANGE> and <BLUE>. When a modifier key is pressed, the soft keyboard icon
located in the right-hand corner of the taskbar is replaced by the shift-state indicator
icon. To distinguish a ‘locked’ modifier key–a key that has been locked ‘on’–from
a modifier key that is only active until the next key is pressed, ‘locked’ keys are
encircled in a black frame in the shift-state indicator icon. Refer to “Activating
Modifier Keys” on page 28 for details.
4.8 Programs–Using Applications
•
Tap Start, Programs to display the programs installed on your WORKABOUT PRO.
Figure 4.24 Program Screen Icons
Opening An Application
•
Tap on an icon in this screen to launch the associated program.
Minimizing An Application
•
Note:
Tap on the X button in the upper-right corner of an application screen to
minimize the application.
Although it looks like a Close button, this button does not close the application–it only minimizes it.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
61
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Settings
Closing An Application
•
•
Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the System tab and then the Memory
icon–the Memory screen is opened.
Tap on the Running Program tab to view a list of running applications.
Figure 4.25 Memory Screen–Running Programs Tab
•
Tap on the application you want to shut down, and then tap on the Stop
button. Tap on Stop All if you want to shut down all running applications,
or tap on Activate to enable an application.
4.9 Settings
•
Tap Start, Settings to display the setting options for your WORKABOUT PRO.
Figure 4.26 Settings Icons
Settings are divided into three tabs–Personal, System and Connections. Refer to
Chapter 6: Settings for details about the options available to you.
62
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Help
4.10 Help
Tapping on the Help option displays a screen in which you can tap on the topic
about which you require information.
Figure 4.27 Help Screen
4.11 Entering Text
Note:
For additional information about tailoring text entry using the soft keyboard, the transcriber along with the block recognizer and letter recognizer, refer to “Input” on page 89.
You can enter text using either the Windows Mobile 2003 SE soft keyboard or the
WORKABOUT PRO keyboard. You can also use the Transcriber to handwrite
information directly on the touchscreen using your stylus.
•
Open an existing document or create a new one–you can tap on the New
menu at the bottom of the screen to create a new document.
If you’re using the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard, there are no special steps. Just
begin typing–the text, spaces, etc. will appear in the document.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
63
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Soft Keyboard
4.11.1 Soft Keyboard
The soft keyboard is laid out just like the keypad on a PC keyboard. By tapping the
stylus on letters and modifier keys like the <SHIFT> key, you can enter text in a
document.
Figure 4.28 Soft Keyboard
If the soft keyboard is not already displayed:
•
•
Tap on the arrow in the keyboard icon at the bottom-right corner of the
screen, and choose Keyboard from the pop-up menu.
Tap on the letters in the keyboard to enter text in your document.
To switch to a numeric keyboard:
•
•
Tap on the 123 key in the upper-left corner of the soft keyboard.
Tap on this key again to return to the standard keyboard.
4.11.2 The Transcriber
To access the Transcriber, with your document opened:
•
•
•
64
Tap on the arrow next to the keyboard icon, and choose Transcriber from
the pop-up menu.
Review the introductory screen. It provides some shortcut symbols you can
draw on your screen to work with the Transcriber.
When you’ve finished reading the introductory screen, tap OK.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
The Transcriber
The Transcriber menu and icon bars are displayed at the bottom of the document.
Transcriber icon
Figure 4.29 Transcriber Screen
•
Use your stylus to write a few words anywhere on the screen.
After a few seconds, your words are recognized (or not) and transcribed into your
document.
Note:
Proper character recognition is more successful if you write using large
letters.
Editing Text Within The Transcriber
With your document open, make certain that you are in transcriber mode–the Transcriber icon should be displayed in the lower-right corner of the taskbar.
•
•
Note:
Double-tap to select a word or triple-tap to select a paragraph, or
Draw a line through the text you want to select and wait a few seconds until
the Transcriber highlights the text.
Once the text is highlighted, write the new text that is to replace the highlighted information, or
Press and hold the stylus on the selected text to display a pop-up menu.
Choose Cut, Copy, Paste or Clear (delete).
You can also use the taskbar tools or the shortcuts listed in the introductory screen to help you edit a document within the Transcriber.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
65
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer
4.11.3 Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer
While the Transcriber attempts to recognize natural handwriting and transcribe it,
Block Recognizer and Letter Recognizer attempt to teach you how to conform your
handwriting to what the hand-held can recognize.
Block Recognizer
•
Open a document, and tap on the arrow in the bottom-right corner of the
screen. Choose Block Recognizer.
Input Panel
Recognizer Icon Bar
Figure 4.30 Block Recognizer Screen
There are two points to remember when using Block Recognizer. First, limit your
writing to the Block Recognizer input panel–do not write in the body of the document. Second, write only uppercase letters with your stylus.
•
•
•
•
66
Tap on the ? icon in the Recognizer Icon Bar to display the Character Recognizer screen. This screen provides a visual demonstration of how to enter
letters that will be recognized. Tap on a character in the soft keyboard for a
demonstration of how to form a recognizable letter.
In the Block Recognizer panel, write letters to the left (abc) and numbers to
the right (123) on the input panel. Remember to write using uppercase letters–they will be printed on the screen as lowercase unless you follow the
step below to create an uppercase letter.
To create an uppercase character, draw a line straight up the ‘abc’ panel.
Use the Recognizer Icon Bar to move around the screen, add spaces, special
characters and so on.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 4: Working With Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer
Letter Recognizer
Recognizer Icon Bar
Input Panel
Figure 4.31 Letter Recognizer
There are two points to remember when using Letter Recognizer. First, limit your
writing to the Letter Recognizer Input Panel–do not write in the body of the document. Second, write only lowercase letters with your stylus.
•
•
•
•
Tap on the ? icon in the Recognizer Icon Bar to display the Character Recognizer screen. This screen provides a visual demonstration of how to enter
letters that will be recognized. Tap on a character in the soft keyboard for a
demonstration of how to form a recognizable letter.
To create an uppercase character, write a lowercase letter on the left side
(ABC) of the input panel.
To create a lowercase character, write a lowercase letter in the middle (abc)
of the input panel.
Write numbers on the right side (123) of the input panel.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
67
CONNECTING TO A LAN WITH 802.11b
5
5.1 Installing The 802.11b Radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
5.2 Connecting To A LAN Using An 802.11b Radio
5.2.1 Entering New Settings . . . . . . . . . . .
5.2.2 Authentication Settings . . . . . . . . . .
5.2.3 Deleting A Network . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 73
. 74
. 75
. 76
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
69
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Installing The 802.11b Radio
5.1 Installing The 802.11b Radio
Note:
An instruction sheet is enclosed with each Psion Teklogix 802.11b radio
to walk you through the installation steps.
The WORKABOUT PRO operates with an 802.11b Direct Sequence Spread
Spectrum radio. The CF (Compact Flash) card is easily installed in the unit.
• To begin, remove the battery pack. If your unit is using AC power,
disconnect it.
• Remove the stylus from the end-cap.
• Remove the end-cap at the top of the WORKABOUT PRO–unscrew the
four Phillips head screws from the cap.
Battery Cover
SW1401 Power Switch
End-Cap
Figure 5.1 The End-Cap And The SW1401 Power Switch
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
71
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Installing The 802.11b Radio
•
•
Slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off internal battery power.
With the back of the hand-held facing you, slide the radio (label up) into the
CF slot at the top of the unit until it clicks into place.
Figure 5.2 Inserting A CF Card
Once the radio is installed, you’ll need to attach a mechanical card stopper to hold
the radio in place. Replacements can be ordered separately.
Figure 5.3 Mechanical Stopper
72
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Connecting To A LAN Using An 802.11b Radio
•
Fit the mechanical stopper over the card, and use the four screws provided
to secure the stopper in place. Tighten the screws to a torque of 2 kg(f)-cm
(0.145 lb-ft, 0.196 N-m), or until finger tight.
Mechanical Stopper
Installed
Figure 5.4 Mechanical Stopper Installed
•
•
•
Slide the SW1401 switch to the right to turn power back on.
Replace the end-cap, and tighten the four Phillips screws to secure
the end-cap.
Install the battery, and replace the backplate.
Important:
The WORKABOUT PRO does not support hot swapping cards.
All power sources must be switched off before inserting a card
in the unit.
5.2 Connecting To A LAN Using An 802.11b Radio
Networks that have already been configured are preferred networks and are listed in
Wireless Networks. You can choose to connect to only preferred networks or to
have the WORKABOUT PRO search for and connect to any available network.
1. Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the
Network Cards icon.
The Configure Wireless Networks screen is displayed with the Wireless tab opened.
This tab lists existing networks to which you can connect, and it allows you to add a
new network or modify the settings for an existing network.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
73
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Entering New Settings
Note:
To change network settings, tap the stylus on a network. If the network for
which you are looking is not listed, tap on ‘Add new...’ and follow the
instructions on the screen.
2. In the Networks to access drop-down menu, choose All Available,
Only access points or Only computer-to-computer depending on the
type of network(s) to which you connect.
3. To connect only to networks you have already configured, disable the
checkbox next to Automatically connect to non-preferred networks.
Note:
If you choose to automatically connect to non-preferred networks, your
WORKABOUT PRO will detect any new networks and provide the
screens necessary to configure them.
5.2.1 Entering New Settings
A wireless network can be added manually or it can be added automatically when
the network is detected.
Note:
If the network is automatically detected. you can skip step 1 and step 2.
1. To manually enter new settings, tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab.
2. Tap on the Network Cards icon. In the Wireless tab, tap on Add new.
3. In the General tab, type a network name. If a network was detected, the
network name is automatically entered and cannot be changed.
4. In the Connects to drop-down menu, choose what your network will
use to connect–Work or Internet.
5. To use an ad-hoc connection, enable This is a device-to-computer
(ad-hoc) connection.
6. Tap on OK to save your changes.
74
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Authentication Settings
5.2.2 Authentication Settings
You can add a network automatically when a network is detected, or you can enter
setting information manually. Contact your network administrator for the
appropriate authentication information.
Note:
If the network is automatically detected, you can skip step 1 and step 2.
1. To manually enter new settings, tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab.
2. Tap on the Network Cards icon. In the Wireless tab, tap on Add new....
3. To use data encryption, tap Network Key, Data encryption (WEP
enabled). WEP (Wired-Equivalent Privacy) encryption prevents others
from accidentally accessing your network.
4. To use Shared Key authentication, tap on Network Authentication
(Shared mode). You’ll need a network key if you choose this option.
802.11b supports two subtypes of network authentication services: Open
and Shared. Under Open authentication, any wireless station can request
authentication. The station that needs to authenticate with another wireless
station sends an authentication management frame that contains the identity
of the sending station. The receiving station then sends back a frame that
indicates whether it recognizes the identity of the sending station.
Under Shared authentication, each wireless station is assumed to have
received a secret shared key over a secure channel that is independent
from the 802.11b wireless network communications channel.
5. To use an automatically assigned network key, enable the checkbox next to
The Key is provided for me automatically, or
To assign a Network key manually, disable the checkbox next to The key is
provided for me automatically, and enter the information manually.
This text box is used to specify a 5 or 13 ASCII character sequence or an
equivalent 10 or 26 Hexadecimal digit sequence that matches the active
WEP key on the access point.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
75
Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b
Deleting A Network
6. To increase security, tap the 802.1x tab followed by Use IEEE 802.1x
network access control.
802.1x is the IEEE standard that offers additional security for local area
networks. It provides authentication for user devices attached to an
Ethernet network, whether wired or wireless. A security protocol
packet such as TLS or MD5 encapsulated in an “EAP” is used in conjunction with the “802.1x” standard to authenticate users at the MAC
layer. Available EAPs are listed in the drop-down menu next to the
EAP type.
7. Choose the appropriate EAP (Extensible Authentication Protocol)
type.
5.2.3 Deleting A Network
Your WORKABOUT PRO keeps a record of each wireless network to which it
connects. The Wireless Networks box in the Wireless tab can get quite full.
To delete an option from the Wireless Networks list:
1. Tap and hold the stylus on the network connection you want to delete.
2. Choose Delete from the pop-up menu.
76
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
6
SETTINGS
6.1 Personal Settings . . . . . . . . .
6.2 Buttons Icon. . . . . . . . . . . .
6.2.1 Up/Down Control. . . . . .
6.2.2 One Shots . . . . . . . . . .
6.2.3 Keyboard Macro Keys . . .
6.2.4 Unicode Mapping. . . . . .
6.2.5 Scancode Remapping . . . .
6.3 Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.3.1 Input Method Tab . . . . . .
6.3.1.1 Word Completion .
6.3.2 Options–Additional Choices
6.4 Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.4.1 Start Menu Tab . . . . . . .
6.4.2 New Menu Tab . . . . . . .
6.5 Owner Information . . . . . . . .
6.6 Password . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7 Sound & Notifications . . . . . .
6.7.1 Sounds . . . . . . . . . . .
6.7.2 Notifications . . . . . . . .
6.8 Today Screen . . . . . . . . . . .
6.8.1 Appearance . . . . . . . . .
6.8.2 Items . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.9 System Settings . . . . . . . . . .
6.10 About . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.11 About Device . . . . . . . . . .
6.12 Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.12.1 Battery Power . . . . . . .
6.12.2 External Power . . . . . .
6.12.3 Intensity . . . . . . . . . .
6.13 Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.13.1 Choosing A Certificate . .
6.14 Clock & Alarms . . . . . . . . .
6.15 Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 81
. 81
. 82
. 82
. 84
. 85
. 87
. 89
. 89
. 93
. 94
. 94
. 94
. 95
. 95
. 96
. 96
. 96
. 97
. 97
. 97
. 98
. 98
. 99
. 99
. 99
.100
.100
.101
.101
.103
.103
.103
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
77
Chapter 6: Settings
6.15.1 Main Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.15.2 Storage Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.15.3 Running Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16 Power Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.1 Battery Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.2 Wireless Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.3 Advanced Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.4 Battery Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.5 Card Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.16.6 Built-In Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.17 Regional Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.18 Remove Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.19 Screen Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20 Scanner Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1 Decoded (Internal) Scanners. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.1 Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner . . .
6.20.1.2 Data Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner.
6.20.1.3 Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.4 Code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.5 EAN 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.6 EAN 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.7 UPC A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.8 UPC E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.9 UPC/EAN Shared Settings . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.10 Codabar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.11 Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.12 Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.13 MSI Plessey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.14 Discrete 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.15 2D PDF-417 (not supported) . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.16 2D Micro PDF-417 (not supported) . . . . .
6.20.1.17 2D RSS Code (not supported) . . . . . . . .
6.20.1.18 Composite (not supported) . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2 Decoded (Intermec ISCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.1 Code 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.2 Code 128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.3 UPC A Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.4 UPC E Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
78
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
103
104
104
105
105
105
106
107
107
108
108
109
109
110
111
112
114
115
118
119
119
120
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
126
126
127
128
128
129
129
129
129
Chapter 6: Settings
6.20.2.5 EAN 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.6 EAN 13 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.7 UPC/EAN Shared Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.8 Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.9 Discrete 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.10 Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.11 Codabar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.12 Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.2.13 MSI Plessey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3 Imager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.1 Options – Imager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.2 Code 39 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.3 Code 128 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.4 UPC/EAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.5 Codabar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.6 Code 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.7 Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.8 Postal: Australian. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.9 Postal: Japanese . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.10 Postal: Korean. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.11 Postal: PlaNET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.12 Postal: PostNET. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.13 Postal: Royal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.14 2D DataMatrix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.15 2D Maxicode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.16 2D PDF-417. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.17 2D Micro PDF-417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.18 2D QR Code. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.19 2D RSS Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.20 Aztec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.3.21 Composite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.4 Options Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.20.5 Translations Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21 Wireless WAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.1 Taskbar Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.2 Establishing A Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.3 Disconnecting From A Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.3.1 Shutting Down The Wireless WAN User Interface
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.129
.130
.130
.130
.130
.131
.131
.131
.131
.132
.132
.133
.134
.134
.134
.134
.135
.135
.135
.135
.135
.136
.136
.136
.136
.137
.137
.137
.137
.137
.138
.138
.140
.141
.141
.143
.144
.144
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
79
Chapter 6: Settings
6.21.4 Advanced Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.4.1 Entering A PIN Number . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.4.2 Error States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.5 Tools Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.5.1 Data Connection Configuration. . . . . . .
6.21.5.2 Security Configuration . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.5.3 Network Configuration . . . . . . . . . . .
6.21.5.4 Driver Mode Configuration . . . . . . . . .
6.21.5.5 Modem Information. . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.22 Total Recall. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.22.1 Creating A Backup Profile. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.22.2 Restoring A Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.23 Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.23.1 Connecting To The Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.23.2 Modem Connection Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.23.2.1 Advanced Modem Settings . . . . . . . . .
6.24 Setting Up A Network Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.1 Changing Network Card Settings . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.2 VPN Connection Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.3 Managing An Existing Connection . . . . . . . . .
6.24.3.1 Editing A Connection . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.3.2 Changing A Connection Setting Name . . .
6.24.4 Selecting A Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.5 Ending A Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.6 Proxy Server Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.24.6.1 Changing Advanced Proxy Server Settings
6.24.7 Wireless Network Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25 Bluetooth Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25.1 Bluetooth Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25.2 Scanning For A New Device . . . . . . . . . . . .
6.25.3 The Bluetooth GPRS Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . .
80
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
144
144
145
146
146
150
151
152
153
154
155
157
158
158
159
161
164
165
166
167
167
168
169
170
170
171
171
172
172
173
175
Chapter 6: Settings
Personal Settings
The Settings screen is divided into three tabs–Personal, System and Connections
•
Tap on Start, Settings to display this screen.
Figure 6.1 Settings Tabs
6.1 Personal Settings
The Personal tab allows you to tailor the general behaviour of your WORKABOUT
PRO, defining input methods, Start menu options, owner information, password
assignment, and sound specifications. You can also determine which items will
appear in the Today screen.
6.2 Buttons Icon
•
Note:
Double-tap on this icon to display your options.
The ‘Program Buttons’ option is not available on this unit.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
81
Chapter 6: Settings
Up/Down Control
6.2.1 Up/Down Control
Figure 6.2 Buttons–Up/Down Control Tab
Sliding the Delay before first repeat bar to the left decreases the delay between key
repeats while sliding the bar to the right increases the repeat delay time.
Sliding the Repeat rate bar to the left slows the rate at which a key repeats when
pressed. Sliding the bar to the right increases the key repeat rate.
6.2.2 One Shots
Figure 6.3 One Shot Tab
The options in this tab allows you to determine how modifier keys on your WORKABOUT PRO behave. For each modifier key–<ALT>, <SHIFT>, <CTRL>,
82
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
One Shots
<ORANGE> and <BLUE>–you have the following options in the drop-down
menu: Lock, OneShot, and OneShot/Lock.
When a modifier key is pressed, it is represented in the soft keyboard in the taskbar
at the bottom of the screen. Modifier keys that are locked ‘on’ are bordered in a
black frame.
Important:
Once you’ve assigned a One Shot mode to a modifier key, you
need to tap on the <OK> button at the top of the tab to activate
your selection.
Lock
If you choose Lock from the drop-down menu, pressing a modifier key once locks it
‘on’ until you press the modifier key a second time to unlock or turn it off.
OneShot
If you choose OneShot, the modifier key remains active only until the next key is pressed.
OneShot/Lock
OneShot/Lock allows you to combine these functions. When you choose this
option and you press the modifier key once, it remains active only until the next key
is pressed.
If you press the modifier key twice, it is locked ‘on’, remaining active until the
modifier key is pressed a third time to turn it ‘off’.
Show Modifier Key State
When you enable Show modifier key state, each time a modifier key is pressed, a
Shift-State Indicator icon
replaces the soft keyboard icon in the taskbar at the
bottom of the screen. A modifier key displayed in the Shift-State Indicator icon with
a black frame around it indicates that the key is locked ‘on’.
ENTER/ON Key Emulates D-Pad
Enabling this option forces the <ENTER> key to behave as it would on a directional
pad. ENTER/ON key emulates D-Pad action is disabled by default. This option
should be enabled or disabled according to personal preference or the requirements
of the application you are using.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
83
Chapter 6: Settings
Keyboard Macro Keys
6.2.3 Keyboard Macro Keys
Figure 6.4 Macro Dialog Box
A macro has 20 programmable characters (or “positions”). The macro keys can be
programmed to replace frequently used keystrokes, along with the function of
executable keys including <ENTER>, <BKSP> and <DEL> (<BLUE>-<BKSP>),
function keys, and arrow keys.
Recording And Saving A Macro
You can program up to 15 macro keys.
•
In the Macro menu, highlight a macro key number–for example, macro 1 to
assign a macro to macro key <M1>. Tap on the Record Macro button.
A Record Macro screen is displayed instructing you to Enter the key strokes to record.
Figure 6.5 Recording A Macro
84
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Unicode Mapping
•
•
Type the macro sequence you want to assign to the Macro key. You can
type text and numbers, and you can program the function of special keys
into a macro.
When you’ve finished recording your macro sequence, tap on the
Stop Recording button.
A new screen–Verify Macro–displays the macro sequence you created.
•
Tap on the Save button to save your macro.
Executing A Macro
•
Press the macro key to which you’ve assigned the macro. For example, if
you created a macro for macro key ‘1’, press <M1> (<ORANGE><O>) to
execute the macro.
Deleting A Macro
•
•
In the Macros tab, highlight the macro number you want to delete.
Tap on the Delete button.
6.2.4 Unicode Mapping
•
Tap on the Unicode Mapping tab to display this screen.
Figure 6.6 Unicode Mapping Tab
The Unicode Mapping tab is used to map combinations of virtual key values and
<CTRL> and <SHIFT> states to Unicode™ values. This tab shows the configured
Unicode character along with the Unicode value. For example, “a (U+0061)”
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
85
Chapter 6: Settings
Unicode Mapping
indicates that the character “a” is represented by the Unicode value “0061”, and so
on. Keep in mind that Unicode configurations are represented as hexidecimal rather
than decimal values.
All user-defined Unicode mappings are listed in the Unicode Mapping tab in order
of virtual key value, and then by order of the shift state. If a Unicode mapping is not
listed, the Unicode mapping is mapped to the default Unicode value.
Adding And Changing Unicode Values
Important:
•
Changes to Unicode mappings are not saved until you exit the
Unicode Mapping tab by tapping on <OK>.
Tap on the Add/Change button.
Figure 6.7 Adding And Changing Unicode Values
•
•
Note:
Highlight a value in the Unicode mapping list.
Position the cursor in the Unicode Mapping field, and type a Unicode
value for the highlighted key.
To add a shifted state–<SHIFT> and/or <CTRL>, tap on the checkbox
next to ‘SHIFT Pressed’ and/or ‘CTRL Pressed’.
Removing Unicode Values
•
86
In the Unicode Mapping tab, highlight the item you want to delete, and tap
the Remove button.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Scancode Remapping
6.2.5 Scancode Remapping
A scancode is a number that is associated with a physical key on a keyboard. Every
key has a unique scancode that is mapped to a virtual key, a function, or a macro.
Scancode Remapping allows you to change the functionality of any key on the
keyboard. A key can be remapped to send a virtual key (e.g. VK_F represents the
‘F’ key; VK_RETURN represents the <ENTER/ON> key, etc.), perform a function
(e.g. turn the scanner on, change volume/contrast, etc.) or run a macro.
There are three different tables of scancode mappings: the Normal table, the Blue
table and the Orange table. The Normal table defines unmodified key presses; the
Blue table defines key presses that occur when the <BLUE> modifier is on; the
Orange table defines key presses that occur when the <ORANGE> modifier is on.
The default mappings of these scancodes can be overwritten for each of these three
tables using the Scancode Remapping tab accessed from the Keyboard Properties
dialog box.
Figure 6.8 Scancode Remapping
The first column in the Scancode Remapping tab displays the Scancodes in
hexidecimal. If the scancode is remapped to a virtual key, that virtual key is
displayed in the next column labelled ‘V-Key’. A virtual key that is ‘Shifted’ or
‘Unshifted’ is displayed in the third column labelled ‘Function’.
If the scancode is remapped to a function or a macro, the first and second columns
remain blank while the third column contains the function name or macro key
number (e.g., Macro 2).
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
87
Chapter 6: Settings
Scancode Remapping
Adding A Remap
To add a new remapping:
•
Tap the Add button at the bottom of the dialog box.
The Remap Scancode dialog box is displayed.
Figure 6.9 Remapping A Key
•
Note:
Type the scan code in hexidecimal in the field labelled Scancode.
The ‘Label’ field displays the default function of the scancode you are
remapping.
Virtual Key, Function And Macro
The radio buttons at the bottom of the dialog box allow you to define to what the
scan code will be remapped: Virtual Key, Function or Macro.
When Virtual Key is selected, you can choose to force <SHIFT> to be on or off
when the virtual key is sent. If No Force is selected, the shift state is dependent on
whether the shift state is on or off at the time the virtual key is sent.
When Function is selected, a list of valid functions appears in the dialog box.
When Macro is selected, the macro keys available on your unit are listed in the
dialog box.
•
•
88
Choose Virtual Key, Function or Macro.
Choose a function from the Function list, and tap on OK.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Input
Editing A Scancode Remap
To edit a scancode:
•
•
•
In the Scancode Remapping tab, tap on the remap you want to edit.
Tap on the Edit button, and make the appropriate changes.
Tap on OK to save your changes.
Removing A Remap
To delete a remap:
•
•
In the Scancode Remapping tab, highlight the scancode you want to delete,
and tap on the Remove button.
Tap on OK.
6.3 Input
This icon provides access to text input options you can use to tailor the soft
keyboard, block recognizer, letter recognizer and transcriber along with voice
recording options.
6.3.1 Input Method Tab
Figure 6.10 Input Method Tab
A drop-down menu next to Input method allows you to tailor your methods of
input–Block Recognizer, Keyboard, Letter Recognizer and Transcriber.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
89
Chapter 6: Settings
Input Method Tab
Block Recognizer
Block Recognizer teaches you how to conform your handwriting to what the
hand-held can recognize.
Important:
Refer to “Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer” on page 66
for additional details.
Keyboard Options
Figure 6.11 Keyboard Options
This screen is displayed when you choose Keyboard in the Input method drop-down
menu. You can use it to customize the soft keyboard. You can choose Large Keys or
Small Keys to increase or decrease the size of the keys displayed on the soft
keyboard.
If you enable Use gestures for the following keys–these keys are removed from the
soft keyboard. Gestures are handwriting shortcuts for the keyboard keys.
Letter Recognizer Options
Letter Recognizer teaches you how to conform your handwriting to what the
hand-held can recognize.
Important:
90
Refer to “Block Recognizer And Letter Recognizer” on page 66
for additional details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Input Method Tab
To display additional letter recognition options, tap on the Options button in the
Letter Recognizer screen.
Figure 6.12 Letter Recognizer Quick Settings
These options allow the Letter Recognizer to better interpret any specialized strokes
and accents you may wish to use.
Transcriber Options
When you choose Transcriber as the input method, three tabs of options are
available to you–Quick Settings, Inking and Advanced.
Figure 6.13 Transcriber–Quick Settings Tab
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
91
Chapter 6: Settings
Input Method Tab
Quick Settings
The Quick Settings tab allows you choose the writing direction–the icons indicate
direction. In addition, you can choose to enable or disable the display of the Intro
screen and the sound each time you launch the Transcriber.
Inking
In the Inking tab you are presented with a number of options. Recognition Delay
allows you to determine the time delay between writing something on the
Transcriber screen and its recognition into printed text.
Figure 6.14 Transcriber–Inking Tab
Enabling Add space after automatically adds a space after each word you write.
The Pen option allows you to choose the line Width and Colour.
Finally, tapping on Match Letter Shapes to your writing displays a screen in which
you can learn how best to form letters to help the hand-held to recognize the most
often used characters.
92
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Word Completion
Advanced
In this tab, Shorthand allows you to create a shortened word that the Transcriber
will recognize and expand into a complete word automatically. You can also insert
data such as a date or run a program.
Figure 6.15 Transcriber–Advanced Tab
6.3.1.1
Word Completion
Figure 6.16 Word Completion Tab
This tab speeds the writing process regardless of which input method you choose.
When you begin entering a word, this option displays what it assumes is the complete
word. You can tap on the word presented rather than typing it in its entirety.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
93
Chapter 6: Settings
Options–Additional Choices
6.3.2 Options–Additional Choices
Figure 6.17 Input Options Tab
This tab offers a few choices including choosing a voice recording format, zoom
percentage for writing and typing, automatic capitalization of the first letter in a
sentence and automatic scrolling when you’ve reached the bottom of the screen.
6.4 Menus
Tapping on Start, Settings, Menu icon displays options to you customize menus.
6.4.1 Start Menu Tab
This tab allows you to define the items that will be listed in your Start menu.
Figure 6.18 Start Menu Tab
•
In the Start Menu tab, tap on the items you want to appear in your Start menu.
The chosen items will be listed in your Start menu.
94
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
New Menu Tab
6.4.2 New Menu Tab
This tab allows you to determine the items that will be listed in the New menu that is
available in the Today screen taskbar.
Figure 6.19 New Menu Tab
•
If it’s not already checked, tap in the checkbox next to Turn on New
button menu and then choose the items you want to appear in the
New menu.
You’ll notice that an arrow is displayed next to the New menu in the taskbar attached
to programs such as Excel, Word and so on.
•
Tap on the arrow and then on an option in the menu to launch a program.
6.5 Owner Information
This icon allows you to add your personal information to the WORKABOUT PRO.
Some of this information will be displayed in the desktop Today screen.
Important:
Refer to “Ownership Information” on page 49 for details about
this option.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
95
Chapter 6: Settings
Password
6.6 Password
Figure 6.20 Password And Hint Tab
•
To assign a password, enable Prompt if device unused for, and choose the
amount of idle time after which you will be prompted to enter a password.
• In the Password type drop-down menu, choose the type of password you
want to assign.
• Enter your password in the Password field.
In the Hint tab, you can enter a description to help you remember your password.
6.7 Sound & Notifications
This icon allows you to specify when your WORKABOUT PRO will emit sounds.
6.7.1 Sounds
Figure 6.21 Sounds Tab
•
96
Tap in the checkboxes and radio buttons to enable the event(s) that will
cause your unit to emit a sound.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Notifications
6.7.2 Notifications
Figure 6.22 Notifications Tab
This tab allows you to determine how you are notified about different events.
•
•
Choose an event from the Events drop-down menu.
Choose the type of reminder–a special sound, a message or a flashing light
–from the drop-down menu next to Play sound.
6.8 Today Screen
This icon allows you to tailor the appearance of the Today screen– the desktop screen.
6.8.1 Appearance
Figure 6.23 Appearance Tab
This screen allows you to customize the background displayed on the Today screen.
•
Choose the background you want to use from the list.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
97
Chapter 6: Settings
Items
6.8.2 Items
Figure 6.24 Items Tab
This tab allows you to choose and sort the items that will be listed in the Today screen.
•
•
Tap in the checkbox to the left of the items you want displayed in the
Today screen.
To rearrange the list of items, highlight the item you want to move up or
down and tap on the Move Up or Move Down button. Keep in mind that
the Date cannot be moved.
6.9 System Settings
To display the icons grouped in the System tab:
•
Tap on Start, Settings, and tap on the System tab.
Figure 6.25 System Tab
98
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
About
6.10 About
Tapping on Start, Settings, System tab, and then the About icon displays a grouping
of tabs that provide device information.
Version Tab
This tab outlines the Windows Mobile 2003 SE version, processor information,
memory size and a description of the expansion card, if one is in use.
Device ID Tab
This tab provides fields in which you can assign a Device name and Description
(optional) for the WORKABOUT PRO. This name is used by the WORKABOUT
PRO to identify itself to other devices.
Keep in mind that this must be a unique name across a network. If you are unable to
connect to a network because another device with the same name is already
connected, you’ll need to assign a new name here.
Copyrights
The Copyright tab lists the copyright information for the software loaded on your
WORKABOUT PRO.
6.11 About Device
Tapping on the About Device icon under Settings, System tab provides access to two
tabs related to your WORKABOUT PRO. The Properties tab lists hardware
information related to properties related to your WORKABOUT PRO. The
Copyright tab lists the copyrights that apply to the your hand-held.
6.12 Backlight
Tapping on Start, Settings, System tab followed by the Backlight icon allows you to
determine the power properties of the WORKABOUT PRO.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
99
Chapter 6: Settings
Battery Power
6.12.1 Battery Power
Figure 6.26 Battery Tab
This tab allows you to tailor the unit’s backlight behaviour to best preserve battery life.
• To define how long the backlight should stay on when the WORKABOUT
PRO is not in use, tap in the checkbox to the left of Turn off backlight if
device is not used for.
• Tap on the drop-down menu, and choose the number of seconds or minutes
the backlight will remain on when the hand-held is idle.
• To Turn on backlight when a button is pressed or the screen is tapped,
tap in the checkbox to the left of this option.
6.12.2 External Power
Figure 6.27 External Power Tab
This tab determines the behaviour of the backlight when the hand-held is using
external rather than battery power. Refer to “Battery Power” on page 100 for details
about these options.
100 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Intensity
6.12.3 Intensity
Figure 6.28 Intensity Tab
This tab is used to adjust the light intensity of the display backlight and the keyboard
backlight. Sliding the bar to the left lowers the light intensity, and sliding it to the
right raises the intensity.
6.13 Certificates
A public key is transmitted as part of a certificate. The certificates listed in the
Certificates tabs ensure that the submitted public key is, in fact, the public key that
belongs to the submitter. The hand-held checks that the certificate has been digitally
signed by a certification authority that the hand-held explicitly trusts.
Your WORKABOUT PRO has certificates already preinstalled in the unit. Two
types of certificates can be stored on your WORKABOUT PRO: personal
certificates that establish your identity and root certificates that establish the identity
of the servers with which you can connect.
•
•
Tap on Start, Settings, and then tap on the System tab.
Tap on the Certificates icon.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 101
Chapter 6: Settings
Certificates
Personal Tab
Figure 6.29 Personal Tab
The Personal tab lists the name of the certificate issuer and the expiration date. You can
tap on an item in the list to view additional information about a particular certificate.
•
•
To view more information about a personal certificate, tap on a certificate in the list.
To delete a certificate, tap and hold the stylus on the item you want to delete
until a pop-up menu is displayed. Tap on the Delete command.
Root Certificates
Figure 6.30 Root Tab
•
•
•
To view details about a certificate—who issued the certificate, to whom it
was issued, the issue date and the expiry date—tap on a certificate in the list.
To delete a certificate, tap and hold the stylus on a certificate.
In the pop-up menu, tap on the Delete command.
102 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Choosing A Certificate
6.13.1 Choosing A Certificate
Normally, certificates already configured for your network are chosen automatically
by the WORKABOUT PRO. If a certificate cannot be chosen automatically, you
must choose it from the Certificates list.
•
To choose a certificate, tap the desired certificate. Your WORKABOUT
PRO will connect automatically.
6.14 Clock & Alarms
Located under Start, Settings, System tab, the Clock & Alarm icon allows you to set
the current date and time, and it allows you to set up to three alarms.
Important:
Refer to“Today’s Date, Clock And Alarm” on page 47 for details
about setting up these options.
6.15 Memory
Figure 6.31 Main Tab
6.15.1 Main Tab
This tab indicates the memory allocated for file and data storage and for program
storage
• Slide the tab to the left or right to adjust the file and data storage versus
program storage–the values change as you slide the tab back and forth.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 103
Chapter 6: Settings
Storage Card
6.15.2 Storage Card
Figure 6.32 Storage Card Tab
The Storage Card screen indicates the total storage card memory along with the
amount in use.
6.15.3 Running Programs
Figure 6.33 Activating And Closing Applications
This tab acts as a task manager, allowing you to activate or stop any running programs.
To close an application:
•
Tap on the application(s) you want to end, and then tap on the Stop button.
Tap on Stop All if you want to shut down all running applications, or
Tap on Activate to make an application active.
104 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Power Icon
Note:
Keep in mind that the ‘X’ button in the upper-right corner of an application screen does not close the application–it only minimizes it.
6.16 Power Icon
This icon allows you to view and manage battery use.
6.16.1 Battery Tab
Figure 6.34 Battery Tab
This tab allows you to view the remaining battery capacity of the main battery and
the internal, backup battery.
6.16.2 Wireless Tab
Figure 6.35 Wireless Options
This tab allows you to turn the WORKABOUT PRO’s wireless capabilities on and off.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 105
Chapter 6: Settings
Advanced Tab
6.16.3 Advanced Tab
Figure 6.36 Advanced Tab
The Advanced tab allows you to manage battery consumption.
On Battery Power
When the WORKABOUT PRO is operating on battery power, this option allows
you to determine how long the unit will remain on when it is not in use.
•
Tap in the checkbox to the left of On battery power to enable this option.
Tap in the drop-down menu to choose the number of minutes your unit can
remain idle before it shuts down.
On External Power
When the hand-held is drawing external rather than battery power, this option allows
you to determine the number of minutes the unit will remain on when not in use.
•
Tap in the checkbox to the left of On external power to enable this option.
Tap in the drop-down menu to choose the number of minutes your unit can
remain idle before it shuts down.
106 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Battery Details
6.16.4 Battery Details
Figure 6.37 Battery Details Tab
This tab lists the specifications and battery capacity status of the battery installed in
the WORKABOUT PRO. This is a view-only screen.
6.16.5 Card Slots
Figure 6.38 Card Slots Tab
When you enable one or more of the options listed in this tab, power is supplied to
the enabled slot(s). Tapping on the Apply button activates your choices.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 107
Chapter 6: Settings
Built-In Devices
6.16.6 Built-In Devices
Figure 6.39 Built-In Device Tab
This tab allows you to enable power to the device(s) installed in your unit. Keep in
mind that contents of this screen varies depending on the devices installed in your
hand-held. Tapping on the Apply button activates your selections.
6.17 Regional Settings
To display the Regional Settings screen, tap on Start, Settings, and then tap on the
System tab followed by the Regional Settings icon.
Figure 6.40 Region Tab
•
Tap on the drop-down menu to choose your language and region.
108 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Remove Programs
Once you’ve selected a language and region, you may need to adjust the way
numbers, currency, the time and the date appear in your WORKABOUT PRO.
•
Tap on the tab associated with each of the items and choose how you want
items to be displayed on your WORKABOUT PRO.
6.18 Remove Programs
Figure 6.41 Remove Programs Screen
Tapping on the Remove Programs icon displays a screen listing the programs that
can be removed from your unit.
•
To remove a program in storage memory, highlight it and then click on the
Remove button.
6.19 Screen Icon
This icon allows you to align (calibrate) your touchscreen, turn ClearType on and
off and adjust the size of the text displayed on the WORKABOUT screen.
•
Tap Start, Settings.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 109
Chapter 6: Settings
Scanner Settings
•
Tap on the System tab, and then tap on the Screen icon.
Figure 6.42 Alignment Screen
Important:
Refer to “Aligning (Calibrating) The Touchscreen” on page 36
for details about this option.
6.20 Scanner Settings
The Teklogix Scanners icon in the Settings menu provides access to dialog boxes in which
you can tailor bar code options and choose the bar codes your scanner will recognize.
•
Tap on Settings, and then tap on the System tab followed by the Teklogix
Scanner icon.
Figure 6.43 Barcode Tab
110 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Decoded (Internal) Scanners
The Scanner
The dropdown menu to the right of the Scanner option allows you to choose from one
of the following scanner types used with your hand-held: Decoded (internal), Decoded
(Intermec ISCP) and Imager.
The symbologies listed in the Barcodes tab change to reflect the scanner you choose and
the bar codes it supports.
Important:
To improve the decode speed and performance, enable only those
codes that are required by the application.
Keep in mind that some bar code types are only available when an internal imaging
scanner is installed. All internal scanners can be configured using the Barcode
dialog boxes.
6.20.1 Decoded (Internal) Scanners
Note:
Bar codes that are not supported are clearly indicated in the manual.
Figure 6.44 Decoded Scanner Settings
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 111
Chapter 6: Settings
Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner
6.20.1.1 Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner
Dot Time (msec)
The value selected for “Dot Time (msec)” determines (in milliseconds) how long
the targeting dot remains on before the scanner switches to a normal scan sweep.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
enter a value of 0 msec, 200 msec or 400 msec. A value of 0 (zero) disables the
target dot.
Laser On Time
The value assigned to this parameter determines how long the laser will remain on
when the scan button or trigger is pressed.
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a
value between 5 and 99, each number representing 0.1 seconds.
Low Power Timeout
To extend laser life, you can select the time the scanner remains active following a
successful decode. The scanner wakes from low power mode when a bar code is
scanned–a successful decode restores normal blinking.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
choose a value of 30 sec, 1 min, 2 min or 3 min.
Parameter Scanning
Setting this parameter to on enables decoding of parameter bar codes.
Linear Security Level
There are four levels of decode security for linear code types (e.g., Code 39, Interleaved
2 of 5). Higher security levels should be selected for decreasing levels of bar code
quality. As security levels increase, the scanner’s aggressiveness decreases. This
parameter allows you to select the security level appropriate for your bar code quality.
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a
value from 1 to 4.
112 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner
Linear security level 1 specifies that the following code types must be successfully
read twice before being decoded:
Code Type
Length
Codabar
All
MSI Plessey
4 or less
D 5 of 5
8 or less
I 2 of 5
8 or less
Table 6.1 Linear Security Level 1
Linear security level 2 specifies that all types of codes must be successfully read
twice before being decoded.
Linear security level 3 specifies that code types other than the following must be
successfully read twice before being decoded. The following codes must be read
three times:
Code Type
Length
MSI Plessey
4 or less
D 2 of 5
8 or less
I 2 of 5
8 or less
Table 6.2 Linear Security Level 3
Linear security level 4 requires that all code types be successfully read three times
before being decoded.
Bi-Direction Redundancy
Note:
This parameter is only valid if a” Linear Security Level” is enabled.
When this parameter is enabled, a bar code must be successfully scanned in both
directions (forward and reverse) before being decoded.
2D Scanning Mode
(not supported)
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
choose one of the following scanning modes: Smart Raster, Always Raster,
Programmable Raster, Slab Pattern, Cyclone Pattern or Semi-Omni Pattern.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 113
Chapter 6: Settings
Data Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner
2D Raster Height And 2D Raster Expand Rate
(not supported)
These parameter determine the laser pattern’s height and rate of expansion.
Note:
These parameters are only used when either Programmable Raster or
Always Raster is assigned to the “2D Scanning Mode” parameter.
“2D Raster Height” and “2D Raster Expand Rate” are intended
for very specific applications, and are usually not required for normal
scanning purposes.
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a
value from 1 to 15.
6.20.1.2 Data Options — Decoded (Internal) Scanner
Transmit Code ID Char
A code ID character identifies the scanned bar code type. In addition to any single
character prefix already selected, the code ID character is inserted between the
prefix and the decoded symbol.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
choose a transmit code: None, AIM or Symbol.
Scan Data Format
This parameter allows you to change the scan data transmission format.
Double-tapping on “Scan Data Format” displays the following options from which
you can choose a data format: data (as-is), data <S1>, data <S2>, data <S1><S2>,
<P> data, <P> data <S1>, <P> data <S2> and <P> data <S1><S2>.
Prefix <P>, Suffix <S1> And Suffix <S2>
A prefix and/or one or two suffixes may be appended to scan data for use in data editing.
When you double-tap on these parameters, a dialog box is displayed in which you
can enter a value from 0 to 255.
Delete Char Set ECIs
(not supported)
Setting this parameter to on enables the scanner to delete any escape sequences
representing Character Set ECIs – Extended Channel Interpretations (also known as
GLIs) from its buffer before transmission.
114 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 39
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from PDF417 and
MicroPDF417 bar codes containing Character Set ECIs, even when the ECI
Protocol is disabled.
ECI Decoder
(not supported)
Setting this parameter to on enables the scanner to interpret any Extended Channel
Interpretations (ECIs) supported by the scanner. This parameter has no effect on
symbols that were not encoded using ECIs.
If this parameter is set to off and a symbol that was encoded using an ECI escape is
scanned, the scanner transmits the ECI escape followed by the uninterpreted data.
6.20.1.3 Code 39
Enabled
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 39”.
Enable Trioptic Code 39
Note:
“Trioptic Code 39” and “Full ASCII” should not be enabled simultaneously. The scanner does not automatically discriminate between these
two symbologies.
Trioptic Code 39 symbols always contain six characters. Setting this parameter to
on allows this type of symbology to be recognized.
Convert To Code 32
Note:
“Code 39” must be enabled in order for this parameter to function.
Setting this parameter to on allows the scanner to convert the bar code from “Code
39” to “Code 32”.
Code 32 Prefix
Note:
“Convert to Code 32” must be enabled in order for this parameter to
function.
When this parameter is enabled, the prefix character “A” is added to all “Code 32”
bar codes.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 115
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 39
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “Code 39” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be decoded by your scanner.
Figure 6.45 Set Code Lengths
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 1 to 55.
Check Digit Verification
When this parameter is enabled (set to on), the integrity of a “Code 39” symbol is
checked to ensure that it complies with specified algorithms.
Note:
Only those “Code 39” symbols that include a Mod 43 check digit are
decoded when this parameter is enabled.
Transmit Check Digit
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must to enabled.
116 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 39
Full ASCII
If this parameter is enabled, the characters +, %, and / are used as escape characters.
The combination of an escape character and the next character
is converted to an equivalent ASCII character.
Decode Performance
If this parameter is enabled, one of three decode levels can be chosen in the “Decode
Performance Level” parameter.
Decode Perf. Level
This parameter provides three levels of decode performance or “aggressiveness” for
Code 39 symbols. Increasing the performance level reduces the amount of required
bar code orientation – this is useful when scanning very long and/or truncated bar
codes. Keep in mind that increased levels reduce decode security.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
enter a decode performance level of between 1 and 3.
Field Size/Chars
Field Size
The field size is the length of the field after the first character is stripped and
the prefix and suffix characters are added. If the field size is non-zero, only
bar codes of that length are passed through.
Prefix Char
This character, if non-zero, is added before a successfully decoded bar code. Press
the key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.
Suffix Char
This character, if non-zero, is added after a successfully decoded bar code. Press the
key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 117
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 128
Strip Leading
This parameter determines the number of characters that will be removed from the
beginning of the bar code before the prefix character is added.
Note:
For Code 39 bar codes, the “AIAG Strip” is performed before the
“Strip Leading”.
Strip Trailing
The value entered in this parameter determines the number of characters that will be
removed from the end of the bar code before the suffix character is added.
6.20.1.4 Code 128
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 128”.
Enable UCC/EAN-128
EAN/UCC bar codes include group separators and start codes. To successfully scan
this type of bar code, “EAN/UCC 128” must be enabled.
Enable ISBT 128
To successfully scan this variation, “Enable ISBT 128” must be set to on.
Decode Performance
If this parameter is set to on, one of three decode levels assigned to the “Decode
Performance Level” parameter can be selected.
Decode Perf. Level
This parameter provides three levels of decode performance or “aggressiveness” for
Code 128 symbols. Increasing the performance level reduces the amount of required
bar code orientation – this is useful when scanning very long and/or truncated bar
codes. Keep in mind that increased levels reduce decode security.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
enter a decode performance level of between 1 and 3.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
118 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
EAN 13
6.20.1.5 EAN 13
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 13”.
Prefix/Suffix
Prefix Char
This character, if non-zero, is added before a successfully decoded bar code. Press
the key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.
Suffix Char
This character, if non-zero, is added after a successfully decoded bar code. Press the
key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.
Strip Leading
This parameter determines the number of characters that will be removed from the
beginning of the bar code before the prefix character is added.
Note: The appended character is treated as any other keyboard character.
For example, if <BKSP> is pressed, the usual action for that key
is performed.
Strip Trailing
The value entered in this parameter determines the number of characters that will be
removed from the end of the bar code before the suffix character is added.
6.20.1.6 EAN 8
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 8”.
EAN-8 Zero Extend
When this parameter is enabled, five leading zeros are added to decoded EAN-8
symbols, making them compatible in format to EAN-13 symbols. Disabling this
parameter returns EAN-8 symbols to their normal format.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 119
Chapter 6: Settings
UPC A
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.1.7 UPC A
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC A”.
UPC-A, Check Digit
If you enable this parameter, the check digit is included with the decoded bar
code data.
UPC-A, Preamble
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed where you can
choose one of three options for lead-in characters for UPC-A symbols transmitted to
the host device: System Char – system character transmitted with the data, Country
code and System Char – both the country code (“0” for USA) and system character
are transmitted with the data or None – no preamble is transmitted. The lead-in
characters are considered part of the symbol.
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.1.8 UPC E
Enabled UPC-E
Set this parameter to on to allow “UPC E” bar code scans.
Enabled UPC-E1
Set this parameter to on to allow “UPC-E1” (zero suppressed) bar code scans.
UPC-E And UPC-E1 Check Digit
If you enable one or both of these parameters, a check digit is included with the
decoded bar code data.
120 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
UPC/EAN Shared Settings
UPC-E And UPC-E1 Preamble
When you double-tap on one of these parameters, a dialog box is displayed where
you can choose one of three options for lead-in characters for UPC-E and UPC-E1
symbols transmitted to the host device: System Char – system character transmitted
with the data, Country code and System Char – both the country code (“0” for
USA) and system character are transmitted with the data or None – no preamble is
transmitted. The lead-in characters are considered part of the symbol.
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A
This parameter converts UPC-E (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC-A format
before transmission. After conversion, data follows UPC-A format and is affected
by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A
This parameter converts UPC-E1 (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC-A format
before transmission. After conversion, data follows UPC-A format and is affected
by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.1.9 UPC/EAN Shared Settings
The parameters you set here are a shared across all available UPC and EAN
bar codes.
Enable Bookland EAN
Setting this parameter to on allows your scanner to recognize “Bookland EAN”
bar codes.
Supplementals
'Supplementals” are additionally appended characters (2 or 5).
Double-tapping this parameter displays a list of options. If Ignore is chosen,
UPC/EAN is decoded and the supplemental characters are ignored. If Decode is
chosen, UPC/EAN symbols are decoded with supplementals. Autodiscriminate
works in conjunction with the Supp. Redundancy parameter.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 121
Chapter 6: Settings
Codabar
Supp. Redundancy
With “Autodiscriminate” selected in the “Supplementals” parameter, “Supp.
Redundancy” adjusts the number of times a symbol without supplementals is
decoded before transmission.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog is displayed in which you can enter
a value between 2 and 20. A value of 5 or above is recommended when
Autodiscriminate is selected and you are decoding a mix of UPC/EAN symbols with
and without supplementals.
Security Level
This parameter controls the tolerance for decoding edge-to-edge UPC/EAN bar
codes. Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can
choose a level from 0 to 3. Lower values have a lower tolerance for misreads, but
they also increase the time it takes to decode the bar code.
Linear Decode
“Linear Decode” applies to code types containing two adjacent blocks (e.g.,
UPC-A, EAN-8, EAN-13). When enabled (set to on), a bar code is transmitted only
when both the left and right blocks are successfully decoded within one laser scan.
This option should be enabled when bar codes are in proximity to each other.
2D UPC Half Block Stitching
(not supported)
Setting this parameter to on enables “UPC Half Block Stitching” for the SE 3223
omnidirectional engine only.
6.20.1.10 Codabar
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar” or off to disable it.
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “Codabar” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
122 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 93
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 5 to 55.
CLSI Editing
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters
and inserts a space after the first, fifth, and tenth characters of a 14-character
Codabar symbol.
Note:
Symbol length does not include start and stop characters.
NOTIS Editing
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters from decoded
Codabar symbol.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.11 Code 93
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93” or off to disable it.
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “Code 93” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 4 to 55.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 123
Chapter 6: Settings
Interleaved 2 of 5
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.12 Interleaved 2 of 5
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5” .
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “Interleaved 2 of 5” can be set for Any length, Length within a range,
One discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the
number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 4 to 14.
Check Digit Verification
When enabled, this parameter checks the integrity of an I 2 of 5 symbol to
ensure it complies with a specified algorithm – either USS (Uniform Symbology
Specification) or OPCC (Optical Product Code Council).
Transmit Check Digit
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the bar code data.
Convert To EAN 13
If this parameter is enabled, the I 2 of 5 bar code is converted to EAN 13.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
124 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
MSI Plessey
6.20.1.13 MSI Plessey
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “MSI Plessey”.
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “MSI Plessey” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 6 to 55.
Check Digits
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can choose
One or Two check digit(s).
If this parameter is set to One, it is assumed that the last digit is a check digit. If
“Check Digits” is set to Two, it is assumed that the last two digits are check digits.
Note:
If Two check digits is selected, an MSI Plessey “Check Digit Algorithm:
must also be selected. See page 9-88.
Transmit Check Digit
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the bar
code data.
Check Digit Algorithm
When the Two MSI Plessey check digits option is selected, an additional verification
is required to ensure integrity. Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog
box n which you can choose the algorithm to be used: MOD 10/MOD 11 or
MOD 10/MOD 10.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 125
Chapter 6: Settings
Discrete 2 of 5
6.20.1.14 Discrete 2 of 5
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Discrete 2 of 5”.
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2
Lengths for “Discrete 2 of 5” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode
a code type within a specified range from 1 to 12.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.15 2D PDF-417 (not supported)
Enable
Setting this parameter to on enables PDF-417 two dimensional (2D) coding.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.16 2D Micro PDF-417 (not supported)
Enable
Setting this parameter to on enables “2D Micro PDF-417” bar code scanning. Micro
PDF-417 is a multi-row symbology that is useful for applications requiring greater
area efficiency but lower data capacity than PDF-417.
Code 128 Emulation
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from certain Micro
PDF-417 symbols as if it was encoded in Code 128 symbols.
126 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
2D RSS Code (not supported)
If Code 128 Emulation is enabled, the following Micro PDF-417 symbols are
transmitted with one of the following prefixes:
]C1 if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915
]C2 if the first codeword is 908 or 909
]C0 if the first codeword is 910 or 911
If Code 128 Emulation is set to off, the Micro PDF-417 symbols are transmitted
with one of the following prefixes:
]L3
]L4
]L5
if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915
if the first codeword is 908 or 909
if the first codeword is 910 or 911
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.17 2D RSS Code
(not supported)
Enable
Setting this parameter to on enables “2D RSS Code” scanning capability.
Enable RSS-14 (Reduced Space Symbology)
RSS-14 code can be either purely linear or split in half with one half stacked on top
of the other half. Stacking the code reduces the bar code length, and providing the
nominal height of the code is maintained, it can be omni-directionally scanned.
Enable RSS Limited
‘RSS-Limited” is restricted, in that it can only encode 14 digit GTINs (global trade
item number) that begin with either a 0 or a 1. It is not stackable and is not designed
to be read omni-directionally.
Enable RSS Expanded
‘RSS Expanded” uses the same application identifiers as UCC/EAN-128 codes but
it can be split into sections and stacked several rows high, reducing the length of the
symbol, while increasing the capacity of data that can be stored. “RSS Expanded”
code can be omni-directionally scanned.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 127
Chapter 6: Settings
Composite (not supported)
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.1.18 Composite (not supported)
Important:
To successfully read this type of bar code, the two types of
symbologies included in a composite bar code must be enabled.
In addition, “Center Bar Code Only” must be disabled.
A composite symbol includes multi-row 2D components making it compatible with
linear and area CCD scanners along with linear and rastering laser scanners.
The options available for this parameter represent multi-level components of a
composite symbol.
Enable CC-C And Enable CC-AB
To activate these components, set these parameters to on.
Enable TLC-39
This composite component integrates MicroPDF417 with the linear code. Setting
this parameter to on enables this parameter.
6.20.2 Decoded (Intermec ISCP)
Figure 6.46 Decoded Intermec Scanner
•
Tap on the Scanner dropdown menu, and choose Decoded (Intermec ISCP).
128 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 39
6.20.2.1 Code 39
Enable
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 39”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.2 Code 128
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 128”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.3 UPC A Settings
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC A” bar code scanning recognition.
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.2.4 UPC E Settings
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC E”.
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.2.5 EAN 8
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 8”.
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 129
Chapter 6: Settings
EAN 13 Settings
6.20.2.6 EAN 13 Settings
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 13”.
Prefix/Suffix
Refer to page 119 for details.
6.20.2.7 UPC/EAN Shared Settings
The setting assigned to the “Addendum” parameter associated with this option is
shared across all UPC and EAN bar codes.
Addendum
An addendum is a separate bar code, supplementary to the main bar code. This
parameter provides three options: Disabled, Optional and Required. Depending on
the value chosen for this parameter, an addendum is recognized or ignored.
•
•
Double-tap on Addendum to display a dialog box listing your options.
Highlight an item, and tap on OK.
When “Addendum” is set to Disabled, the scanner does not recognize an
addendum. If this parameter is set to Optional, the scanner searches for
an addendum and if one exists, appends it to the main bar code. When the
parameter is set to Required, the scanner does not accept the main bar code
without an addendum.
6.20.2.8 Interleaved 2 of 5
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.9 Discrete 2 of 5
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Discrete 2 of 5”.
130 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 11
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.10 Code 11
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 11”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.11 Codabar
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.12 Code 93
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.2.13 MSI Plessey
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “MSI Plessey”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 131
Chapter 6: Settings
Imager
6.20.3 Imager
Figure 6.47 Imager
•
Tap on the Scanner drop-down menu, and choose Imager.
6.20.3.1 Options – Imager
TekImager Enabled
Setting this option to on enables the imager installed in your hand-held.
Dot Time (msec)
The value selected for “Dot Time (msec)” determines (in milliseconds) how long
the targeting dot remains on before the scanner switches to a normal scan sweep.
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can
enter a value of between 0 and 3000. A value of 0 disables the target dot.
Center Bar Code Only
Note:
This parameter must be disabled when reading Composite bar codes.
When more than one bar code is visible in a single snap shot, this parameter allows
you to specify that only the centre image within the imager framing marker will be
read. When this parameter is set to on, the target dot is pointed at the centre image
and only that image is returned.
132 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 39 Settings
Auto Exposure
Important:
This parameter value should only be changed by qualified Psion
Teklogix personnel. It should be left at the default value – ‘on’.
Setting this parameter to on allows the imager to make automatic gain, integration
and illumination adjustments based on ambient light before capturing the bar code.
If the adjustment is insufficient, further adjustments are made automatically before
another image is captured.
Fast Converge
Note:
“Auto Exposure” must be set to ‘on’ in order for this parameter
to function.
Keep in mind that while this parameter can improve imager performance,
“Fast Converge” increases battery power consumption.
Setting this parameter to on speeds the “Auto Exposure” process. It allows the
imager to rapidly snap a number of bar code capture attempts while finding ideal
values for gain, integration and illumination.
Max Gain, Max Integration And Max Illumination
Important:
These parameter values should only be changed by qualified
Psion Teklogix personnel.
These parameters represent internal units used by the Symagery imager. The “Auto
Exposure” parameter automatically adjusts the “Max Gain”, “Max Integration” and
“Max Illumination” parameters to produce the best bar code read. Keep in mind that
“Auto Exposure” must be set to on in order for these parameter values to be
automatically adjusted.
Double-tapping on any of these parameters displays an associated dialog box in
which an allowable range is displayed: Max Gain – 357 to 7920, Max Integration –
0 to 65535, Max Illumination – 0 to 7.
6.20.3.2 Code 39 Settings
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 39” or off to disable it.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 133
Chapter 6: Settings
Code 128 Settings
6.20.3.3 Code 128 Settings
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 128”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.4 UPC/EAN
This parameter allows you to enable the following UPC (Universal Product Code)
and EAN (European Article Numbering) bar codes: UPC-A, UPC-E, UPC-E1,
UPC-8, EAN-13, Bookland EAN-13 and Bookland EAN.
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC/EAN” bar codes.
Addendum
Refer to “Addendum” on page 130.
Prefix/Suffix
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 119.
6.20.3.5 Codabar
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.6 Code 93
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
134 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Interleaved 2 of 5
6.20.3.7 Interleaved 2 of 5
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.8 Postal: Australian
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Australian”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.9 Postal: Japanese
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Japanese”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.10 Postal: Korean
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Korean”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.11 Postal: PlaNET
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: PlaNET”.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 135
Chapter 6: Settings
Postal: PostNET
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.12 Postal: PostNET
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: PostNET”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.13 Postal: Royal
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Royal”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.14 2D DataMatrix
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D DataMatrix”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.15 2D Maxicode
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D Maxicode”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
136 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
2D PDF-417
6.20.3.16 2D PDF-417
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D PDF-417”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.17 2D Micro PDF-417
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D Micro PDF-417”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.18 2D QR Code
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D QR Code”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.19 2D RSS Code
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D RSS Code”.
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.20 Aztec
Enabled
Set this parameter to on to enable “Aztec”.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 137
Chapter 6: Settings
Composite
Field Size/Char
Refer to page 117 for details.
6.20.3.21 Composite
A composite symbol includes multi-row 2D components making it compatible with
linear and area CCD scanners along with linear and rastering laser scanners.
Important:
To successfully read this type of bar code, the two types of
symbologies included in the composite must be enabled.
In addition, “Center Bar Code Only” must be disabled.
6.20.4 Options Tab
This tab allows you to tailor the double-click parameters and the display options
associated with your scanner.
Figure 6.48 Options Tab
Double Click Parameters
Click Time (msec)
This parameter controls the maximum gap time (in milliseconds) for a double-click.
If the time between the first and second clicks of the scanner trigger is within this
time, it is considered a double-click. The allowable range is 0 to 1000. A value of
zero disables this feature.
138 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Options Tab
A double-click produces different results depending on whether or not a value is
assigned in the “Click Data” parameter. When a value is not assigned for the “Click
Data”, double-clicking the scanner trigger overrides the target dot delay set in the
“Dot Time” parameter and initiates a normal scan sweep. If a value is assigned for
the “Click Data” parameter, double-clicking the scanner trigger inserts the “Click
Data” value rather than initiating a scan.
Click Data
For both integrated and external scanners, this parameter determines which
character is sent to the application installed in your hand-held following a
double-click. A dialog box appears, asking that you press the key you want to insert.
The ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.
Display Parameters
Scan Result
When this parameter is enabled, the type of bar code and the result of the scan
appear on the screen. Note that this information is only displayed after a successful
decode and is visible only while the scanner trigger is pressed. When the trigger is
released, this information is cleared from the screen.
Scan Indicator
When this parameter is enabled, the laser warning logo appears on the display
whenever the scanner is activated.
Scan Result Time (sec)
The value assigned to the “Scan Result Time (sec)” parameter determines how long
the scan results of a successful scan are displayed on the screen. Time is measured in
seconds, and a value of “0” (zero) disables the parameter. When you choose this
option, a dialog box appears where you can enter a value.
Note:
To remove the scan result from the screen before the “Result Time” has
expired, point the scanner away from the bar code and press the trigger.
Good Scan Beep And Bad Scan Beep
These parameters determine whether or not the hand-held emits an audible scanner
‘beep’ when a good (successful) scan or a bad (unsuccessful) scan is performed. Set
these parameters to either on to enable the beeper or off to disable it.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 139
Chapter 6: Settings
Translations Tab
Scan Log File
If this parameter is enabled, the input barcode and the modified/translated output bar
code are logged in the file \Flash Disk\ScanLog.txt. Keep in mind that if the “Scan
Log File” is enabled, there is a slight performance effect when performing multiple
scans since the log file is written to persistent storage.
6.20.5 Translations Tab
Figure 6.49 Translation Tab
•
In the Translation tab, choose the Add button.
Figure 6.50 Translation Dialog Box
140 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Wireless WAN
Input
This value is compared with the decoded bar code reading. If there is a match, the
“Output” string is translated into the decoded bar code.
Output
If there is a match between the decoded bar code and the corresponding “Input”
string, the decoded bar code will be translated into the “Output” string. This string
entry parameter can be null, or it may contain any combination of standard and
special characters (e.g., function keys, <ENTER>, etc.).
Type
The value chosen from this drop-down menu determines what is compared with
the decoded bar code reading – the beginning of decoded bar code, the end of
decoded bar code, the entire decoded bar code or anywhere within the decoded bar
code (default).
6.21 Wireless WAN
A WORKABOUT PRO equipped with a GSM/GPRS or CDMA/1xRTT radio
provides wide area networking capabilities.
6.21.1 Taskbar Icons
Wireless WAN icons in the taskbar indicate the status of your wide area network
connection. Note that these icons are only visible when a GSM/GPRS or
CDMA/1xRTT radio is installed in the unit, and the interface is enabled.
The letter in the signal strength icon (G for GSM/GPRS and X for CDMA/1xRTT)
indicates that a packet data service is available and initialized. Keep in mind that the
signal strength icon is displayed without a letter if packet data service is not
available or if it is available but not yet initialized.
User interaction is required (e.g. the user is required to enter a PIN).
A non-recoverable (fatal) error has occurred.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 141
Chapter 6: Settings
Taskbar Icons
GSM/GPRS Status Indicators
Signal strength is between 1% and 20%.
Signal strength is between 21% and 40%.
Signal strength is between 41% and 60%.
Signal strength is between 61% and 80%.
Signal strength is between 81% and 100%.
A GPRS packet data connection is active.
CDMA/1xRTT
Signal strength is between 1% and 20%.
Signal strength is between 21% and 40%.
Signal strength is between 41% and 60%.
Signal strength is between 61% and 80%.
Signal strength is between 81% and 100%.
A CDMA/1xRTT packet data connection is active.
142 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Establishing A Connection
6.21.2 Establishing A Connection
To display the main Wireless WAN dialog box:
•
Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the System tab followed by the Wireless
WAN icon.
Figure 6.51 Wireless WAN Screen
Note:
If you are prompted to enter a PIN, refer to “Entering A PIN Number” on
page 144 for details.
The Status field indicates when the unit is ready to connect–the Connect Data
button is enabled.
• Tap on the Connect Data button.
The progress of the connection is tracked in the Status field.
• PPP link to modem active
• Authenticating user
• User authenticated
• Connected
Note:
Keep in mind that these states may be displayed fairly quickly if the
progress of the connection is rapid.
When the connection state reaches PPP link to modem active, the taskbar icon
changes to indicate an active connection. The Connect Data button changes,
displaying Disconnect.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 143
Chapter 6: Settings
Disconnecting From A Network
6.21.3 Disconnecting From A Network
To disconnect from the network:
•
Tap on the Disconnect button, and then on OK.
When the WORKABOUT PRO network connection is severed, the Status field
displays Ready to Connect.
A unit equipped with a GSM/GPRS expansion board displays the signal strength in
the main Wireless WAN screen, even while a connection is active. Units equipped
with Sierra Wireless Aircard modems do not display the signal strength while a
connection is active.The Rx bytes and Tx bytes fields estimate the amount of data
transmitted and received, respectively.
6.21.3.1 Shutting Down The Wireless WAN User Interface
While it is not usual to shut down the GSM/GPRS user interface, you can
accomplish this by tapping on File menu and choosing the Exit command in the
Wireless WAN screen.
Note:
Once you’ve shut down the user interface, you can only enable the radio
by tapping on the Wireless WAN icon to display the dialog box.
6.21.4 Advanced Information
In most cases, when a GSM/GPRS radio and SIM are installed in your hand-held,
setup is automatic. Follow the steps outlined under the heading “Establishing A
Connection” on page 143 to make a connection. The information in this section is
for advanced setup purposes.
6.21.4.1 Entering A PIN Number
If a PIN is required, a PIN entry dialog box is displayed.
Figure 6.52 PIN Number
•
Type your PIN, and press <ENTER>.
144 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Error States
Note:
If you exceed the number of allowable attempts, a PUK entry window is
brought to the foreground. You’ll need to enter a new PIN number.
Once the correct PIN or PUK is entered or if none was required, the modem is
instructed to perform a GSM network registration followed by a GPRS attach. The
main Wireless WAN dialog box reflects the progress of the initialization.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Searching for modem
Initializing modem
SIM is ready
Searching for network
Registered on network
Searching for GPRS
Ready to connect
If the modem loses the connection to the GSM network, the following states are
repeated: Searching for network, Registered on network, Searching for GPRS and
Ready to connect.
6.21.4.2 Error States
The following temporary error states (i.e., these states may disappear without
interaction) may be displayed:
•
Emergency calls only
The modem has found a network but is not allowed to register (e.g. no
roaming agreement between networks). The modem keeps searching for
another network.
•
No network found
A network is not currently available. The modem continues searching for a
network.
•
GPRS not available
The current network does not support GPRS.
•
GPRS not allowed
The modem is not allowed to use GPRS on the current network (e.g. no
GPRS roaming agreement between network; a roaming agreement for
voice may still be in place). It is also possible that you do not have a subscription for GPRS at all.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 145
Chapter 6: Settings
Tools Menu
The remaining error states are permanent:
•
SIM is missing
The SIM card is missing. After the SIM has been inserted a warm boot may
be required.
•
SIM failure
The SIM card is permanently disabled (e.g. because the wrong PUK has
been entered too many times). A new SIM is needed.
•
Modem failure
The modem did not respond to commands as expected. If a warm boot does
not clear this condition, the modem may need to be replaced.
•
NDIS error
An internal software error has occurred. If a warm boot does not clear this
condition, Psion Teklogix technical support may need to investigate further.
6.21.5 Tools Menu
The Tools menu in the main Wireless WAN dialog box offers some additional,
advanced setup features.
6.21.5.1 Data Connection Configuration
Figure 6.53 Wireless WAN Data Configuration Screen
146 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Data Connection Configuration
If the Enable automatic connect: checkbox is checked (unchecked by default), the
Wireless WAN user interface will attempt to establish a GPRS connection whenever
GPRS is available (e.g. after resume from suspend without further user interaction).
To activate the automatic connection mode:
•
Tap on the OK button.
While automatic connection mode is enabled, the Connect Data button in the main
Wireless LAN dialog box changes to Disable Auto.
To close the currently active connection (if any) and disables the automatic
connection mode:
•
Tap on Disable Auto.
Important:
Automatic connection mode should not be used if applications
other than the Wireless WAN user interface (e.g. Connection
Manager) are expected to open and close connections.
If the automatic connection mode is enabled and another application closes the GPRS connection then the WWAN user interface
will immediately try to re-establish the connection.
In most cases, the data connection is configured automatically and no user
interaction is required. This is true even if multiple SIM cards from different
operators are used with the same device. The connection parameters are adjusted
automatically when a new SIM card is detected (this may require a warm boot). The
connection parameters are retrieved from a database.
Manual configuration should be necessary only if:
•
•
•
•
One or more parameters in the database are incorrect or a new operator is
not yet in the database. (The database should be corrected for subsequent
software releases.)
An operator has assigned individual GPRS user names and passwords.
A very large site has their own APN. Such connections always have to be
configured manually.
A customer has subscribed for a static IP address. By definition this must be
configured manually.
Important:
For CDMA/1xRTT, automatic configuration is not available –
connections must be configured manually. Under APN, the
packet service access number must be entered (typically “#777”).
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 147
Chapter 6: Settings
Data Connection Configuration
In the following section, all the parameters that need to be configured for a
connection (such as APN, user name, password, DNS server addresses etc.) are
referred to as a profile. Every profile is identified by an arbitrary, unique name. The
profile named Default is special in that it is always present and can neither be edited
nor deleted. (A sample dialog box is presented in Figure 6.53 on page 146.) The
Default profile uses parameters from a built-in database. The home network (the
network that issued the SIM) is used for the database look-up. While there can be
many configured profiles, only one profile can be active at any time.
If connection profiles are configured manually then the Enable automatic
configuration: checkbox should normally be unchecked.
In one particular use case, manually configured profiles may be combined with
automatic configuration. If multiple SIM cards are used with the same device, each
SIM card being from a different operator and some or all of them requiring a
manually set up profile, automatic configuration may be used to automatically pick
the correct manually configured profile for each SIM card. For this to work each
profile has to be configured while the corresponding SIM card is inserted in the
device and initialized (i.e. the status is at least SIM is ready).
The Select profile drop-down list in the data configuration profile selects which
profile a subsequent action applies to. A profile named Default is always present
and contains the current parameters from the database. The following actions are
available:
Show
The parameters for the selected profile are displayed when you tap on this button.
For the Default profile, the publicly known password is shown – otherwise, the
password is hidden.
Edit
The parameters of the selected profile can be edited when you choose the Edit
button. Keep in mind that you cannot edit the Default profile.
Delete
The selected profile is deleted. You cannot delete the Default profile.
148 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Data Connection Configuration
New
Tapping on the New button allows you to create a new profile.
Figure 6.54 Creating A New Profile
The name of the newly created profile must be different from all existing profiles.
Also, the name cannot be Default. When the New Data Profile dialog box is
opened, a proposal for a unique name is filled in the corresponding entry field. If a
manually configured profile has a secret password and unauthorized access to the
device is a concern even after the SIM PIN has been entered, the password should
not be entered in the New Data Profile dialog box and the Prompt user for
password: checkbox should be checked instead. In this case, you will be prompted
for the password each time a connection is initiated (the Connect Data button in the
main Wireless WAN dialog box is selected).
Activate
When this button is chosen, the selected profile is made the active profile.
Activation is possible only if the Enable automatic configuration: checkbox is
unchecked.
Reset
The Reset button in the New Profile and Edit Profile dialog boxes resets all entry
fields to the values they had when the dialog box was opened.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 149
Chapter 6: Settings
Security Configuration
Advanced IP
Figure 6.55 Assigning IP Information
The Advanced IP button in the Show Profile and Edit Profile dialog boxes opens
another dialog box that allows you to configure a static IP address as well as the IP
addresses for the primary and secondary DNS server.
6.21.5.2 Security Configuration
The Security Configuration dialog box is called up through the Tools menu.
Note:
Security configuration is not available with CDMA modems.
The Security Configuration dialog box allows you to enable, disable and change the
PIN. You will need the current PIN to make any of these changes. The PIN must be
enabled in order to be changed. (If the PIN is disabled, the New PIN entry field is
greyed out.)
Note:
Keep in mind that some network operators do not allow the SIM PIN to be
disabled. A new PIN must consist of 4 to 8 numeric digits.
The Require PIN on resume checkbox is independent of the aforementioned
settings. By default, this checkbox is unchecked. While the checkbox remains
unchecked, any PIN entered on startup or through the Security Configuration dialog
box and submitted successfully to the modem is stored in memory for as long as the
device is not rebooted. This stored PIN is then used without further user interaction
whenever the modem requires a PIN (such as resume after suspend or modem
150 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Network Configuration
removal). The stored PIN is also automatically entered in the Current PIN text box
whenever the Security Configuration dialog box is called up.
If unauthorized access to the device is a concern, the Require PIN on resume
checkbox should be checked. In this case, you will be prompted whenever a PIN is
required and the PIN is not stored.
6.21.5.3 Network Configuration
Note:
Network configuration is not available with CDMA modems.
In the main Wireless WAN screen:
•
Tap on the Tools menu, and choose Network.
By default the GSM radio modem automatically chooses from the available and
allowed networks (allowed networks are the home network and all other networks
with which the home network has a roaming agreement). You may find there are
some situations in which you want to override this default behaviour. For example,
you may want to disable roaming if you find yourself in a border area where the
home network is not available but a foreign roaming partner is available. Abroad,
you may find that an available network does not have GPRS roaming agreements.
In this case, you’ll need to manually select the network which you know to support
GPRS roaming.
Automatic network selection is enabled or disabled by checking or unchecking
Enable automatic network select in the Network dialog box. When automatic
network selection is disabled, you must select a network manually.
Available networks can also be viewed without changing any settings. Scanning for
available networks is a lengthy operation – a progress bar is shown while the scan is
active. For every network that is found, the network name, country, status and
numeric network identifier (MCC/MNC, Mobile Country Code followed by the
Mobile Network Code) is displayed.
Note:
Your home network operator will need to let you know which other networks have roaming agreements. Even when a network is listed with an
‘Available’ status, it does not necessarily follow that it can be used or that
the roaming agreement covers GPRS.
A status of ‘Forbidden’ indicates that the network cannot be used. If you
choose a network that is not covered by a roaming agreement, the status in
the main WWAN dialog box changes to ‘Emergency calls only’, ‘No network found’, ‘GPRS not available’ or ‘GPRS not allowed’.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 151
Chapter 6: Settings
Driver Mode Configuration
6.21.5.4 Driver Mode Configuration
Figure 6.56 Driver Mode
By default, the Wireless WAN driver is enabled (the Enable driver: checkbox is
checked). The driver must be disabled in order to use the modem for anything other
than GPRS (e.g. dial-up data, fax, or in order to manually submit AT commands to
the modem for development, testing, approvals, etc.). If the Enable driver:
checkbox is not checked, the driver is shut down as soon as the OK button in the
Driver Mode dialog box used.
If, on the other hand, the Wireless WAN driver is not running and the Enable driver:
checkbox is checked, the Wireless WAN driver is started as soon the Driver Mode
dialog box is closed using the OK button.
Note:
When the driver is not running, no network status or signal strength can
be displayed.
Since all currently supported GSM modems are automatically detected, the Enable
automatic port detection checkbox should always be checked. If this checkbox is
not checked, a serial port can be selected manually. This experimental feature allows
the driver to be used with an internal GSM modem that was not recognized by the
automatic detection or an external GSM modem connected to a serial port of the
computer through USB or through Bluetooth. An external modem connected to a
serial port must support 115.2kbit/s, 8bit, no parity and hardware flow control.
152 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Modem Information
6.21.5.5 Modem Information
The fields in this dialog box cannot be edited – they only display information about
the WORKABOUT PRO modem.
If the network operator has not programmed a user’s phone number into his SIM,
the Phone: field remains empty.
If the main menu shows an error status, at least partial modem information may
be available.
Modem Power Modes
The power mode of the modem is controlled through the Power icon rather than
through the Wireless WAN user interface.
To adjust PC Card and CF card modems settings:
•
•
Tap on Start, Settings, and then tap on the System tab followed by the
Power icon.
Tap on the Card Slots tab.
If the checkbox for a modem is unchecked, power is not applied to the modem and a
driver is not loaded (neither the serial port driver nor the Wireless WAN driver). If
the checkbox is checked, power is applied to the modem and the drivers are loaded
when the hand-held is turned on. Power is removed from the modem when the
WORKABOUT PRO enters suspend mode.
To adjust settings for a modem module that is built into the unit:
•
•
Tap on Start, Settings, and then tap on the System tab followed by the
Power icon.
Tap on the Built-In Devices tab.
Disabled
Power is not applied to the modem and a driver is not loaded.
Enabled–Off in Suspend
Power is applied to the modem and the drivers are loaded when the unit is turned on.
Power is removed from the modem when the hand-held enters suspend mode.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 153
Chapter 6: Settings
Total Recall
Enabled - Automatic Off
When the hand-held enters suspend mode, the modem remains powered up. If the
WORKABOUT PRO is not turned on again during the next 60 minutes, the unit
briefly wakes up from unit mode, shuts down the modem, and enters unit mode
again. This is the default mode.
Enabled - Always On
When the WORKABOUT PRO enters suspend mode, the modem remains
powered indefinitely.
At the cost of a slightly increased power consumption in suspend mode, the modes
where the modem remains powered up during suspend mode have several
advantages. When the unit wakes up from suspend mode the modem is ready
immediately– modem or network initialization is not required. A packet data session
can then remain active during suspend mode. In these modes, the modem is also
able to wake up the hand-held if the network status changes or there is incoming
data on a packet session.
6.22 Total Recall
Total Recall is a Psion Teklogix utility developed to maintain applications and
settings during cold boots. This utility is based on a backup and restore concept.
• Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Total Recall icon.
Figure 6.57 Total Recall Screen
In the drop-down menu, you can choose from four options: Create Backup Profile,
View Selected Profile, Restore Selected Profile and Delete Selected Profile. Keep in
mind however that until a profile is created, the only available option is Create
Backup Profile.
154 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Creating A Backup Profile
6.22.1 Creating A Backup Profile
•
Tap on the Next button to begin the process.
Figure 6.58 Profile Details
Profile Information
This dialog box lists the possible storage destinations for the profile file.
•
To begin, type a name for the profile in the field labelled Profile Name.
This dialog box also lists the image type–OS Version and Registry Type for the
WORKABOUT PRO.
•
•
Tap on the
icon to expand your settings for Profile Type and Profile
Location.
- For this device only–creates a backup that is manually restored by
the operator.
- AutoRestore for this device only–creates a profile that automatically restores itself following a cold boot.
- AutoRestore for this and other devices–creates a profile that automatically restores after resuming from a cold boot, but it will not
contain the touchscreen calibration coordinates or the Wireless
radio settings.
- Profile Location–allows the operator to specify where the profile
is to be saved. The location for the profile will typically be Flash
or a Storage card.
Tap on the Next button to display the next dialog box–Add Files.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 155
Chapter 6: Settings
Creating A Backup Profile
Add Files
Figure 6.59 Adding Files
By default, All Files is selected so that all installed or copied files, database entries,
and the Registry will be saved. You can, however, limit the backup to database,
and/or the registry only.
•
Tap on the Next button to view your selections.
View Selections
Depending on what you have selected for inclusion in your profile, you can view a
list of the selected files, databases, and/or registry.
Figure 6.60 Viewing Selections
•
Tap on the Next button to display the next screen.
156 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Restoring A Profile
Performing The Backup
Figure 6.61 Performing The Backup
•
Tap on the Backup button to start the process and create a profile.
A message is displayed in the Total Recall screen stating that the backup was
completed successfully.
• Tap on Finish to exit Total Recall.
6.22.2 Restoring A Profile
Figure 6.62 File Restoration
To manually restore a profile:
•
Choose Restore Selected Profile from the drop-down menu, and choose
the Profile Name you want to restore in the drop-down menu.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 157
Chapter 6: Settings
Connections
Note:
You can also manually restore an auto restore profile located in flash or a
storage device.
6.23 Connections
Note:
‘Beam’ is not available with the WORKABOUT PRO. This unit is not
equipped with an IrDA port.
You can set up Internet and corporate network connections so that you can browse
the Internet, send and receive e-mail and synchronize information using
ActiveSync. Your WORKABOUT PRO has two groups of connection settings: My
ISP and My Work Network. My ISP is used to connect to the Internet. My Work
Network is used to connect to a private network like the corporate network at your
place of business.
6.23.1 Connecting To The Internet
To activate the connection, make certain that any necessary equipment is installed in
your hand-held such as an Ethernet card.
1. You’ll need the following information from your ISP to make an internet
connection: ISP server phone number, user name and password.
2. Tap Start, Settings, and then tap on the Connections tab.
Figure 6.63 Connections Tab
3. Tap on the Connections icon.
158 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Modem Connection Setup
4. Under My ISP, tap on Add a new modem connection.
5. In the Select a modem drop-down menu, choose a modem connection. If
you haven’t already created a modem connection, refer to “Modem Connection Setup” below.
6. To connect to the Internet, launch the program you want to use. For example,
launch Internet Explorer on your WORKABOUT PRO to browse the Internet. Your hand-held automatically connects.
Note:
To set up a network card or wireless network connection to your ISP, add
a new connection under My Work Network.
6.23.2 Modem Connection Setup
Before you begin, you’ll need the following information from your ISP or network
administrator: telephone number, user name, password, domain name and TCP/IP settings.
If your WORKABOUT PRO does not have access to a mobile phone network,
insert a modem card in the unit.
1. Tap Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the Connections icon.
2. To create a new connection in either My ISP or My Work Network, tap on
Add a new modem connection.
3. In the Make New Connection screen, type a name for the connection.
Figure 6.64 Make A New Connection Screen
4. In the drop-down menu below Select a modem, tap on your modem type.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 159
Chapter 6: Settings
Modem Connection Setup
Note:
If your modem is not listed in the drop-down menu, choose Hayes Compatible on COM1.
5. Tap on the Next button.
Figure 6.65 Phone Connection Screen
6. In the next screen, enter the phone number exactly as you want it dialed. If,
for example, you need to dial 9 for an outside line, enter the 9 at the beginning of the phone number.
7. Tap on the Next button.
Figure 6.66 User Name, Password and Domain
8. Type the User Name, Password and Domain Name as provided by your
ISP or network administrator.
160 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Advanced Modem Settings
Note:
Generally, you will not need to change any of the Advanced settings.
For information about the Advanced settings, refer to“Advanced Modem
Settings” on page 161.
Changes to Advanced settings are only required in the following instances:
To change the baud rate settings, dialing string commands or credit
card options.
To change port settings.
To enter TCP/IP settings because the server to which you are connecting
does not dynamically assign addresses.
9. Tap on the Finish button.
If you need to edit the Advanced settings, refer to “Advanced Modem Settings” in the next section.
6.23.2.1 Advanced Modem Settings
Figure 6.67 General Tab
Baud Rate
•
In the Baud rate drop-down menu, choose a new baud rate. Check your
modem documentation for the appropriate baud rate.
Wait For Dial Tone Before Dialing
•
To speed connection when using a modem, disable this option–tap in the
checkbox to the left of this option.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 161
Chapter 6: Settings
Advanced Modem Settings
Wait For Credit Card
•
If you’re paying for calls with a credit card, enter the number of seconds
you want the WORKABOUT PRO to wait for a credit card prompt.
Extra Dial-String Modem Commands
•
Type your credit card number in this field.
Cancel If Not Connected In
•
Tap in the checkbox next to this option to enable this option to make certain
that the WORKABOUT PRO does not stay on line too long while waiting
to connect with a network.
Enter the number of seconds after which the call will be cancelled.
Note:
By default, you WORKABOUT PRO cancels the call if a connection is not
made after two minutes.
Figure 6.68 Port Settings Tab
Important:
These settings should not be changed unless instructed by your
ISP or network administrator.
Data Bits
This parameter determines the number of bits for the data going through this port.
Possible values are: 4, 5, 6, 7, 8.
162 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Advanced Modem Settings
Parity
This parameter determines the type of parity checking used on the data going
through the port. The options are: none, odd, even, mark and space.
Stop Bits
This parameter specifies the number of stop bits–1, 1.5, 2–used for asynchronous
communication.
Flow Control
This parameter selects the type of flow control used in your hand-held computer.
The WORKABOUT PRO can perform Software or Hardware handshaking, or you
can choose None.
Terminal
The Terminal settings along with your modem allows your WORKABOUT PRO to
connect to an online service or a corporate server that requires TTY or VT-100
terminal emulation. You could, for example, connect to other computers, Telnet sites
and host computers. This option is similar to the HyperTerminal program
capabilities on your PC.
TCP/IP Settings
Figure 6.69 TCP/IP Tab
Important:
If your server assigns IP addresses dynamically, you will not need
to change these settings. If you need to make changes, contact
your ISP or network administrator for addresses.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 163
Chapter 6: Settings
Setting Up A Network Card
Server Settings
Figure 6.70 Servers Tab
Important:
If your server assigns IP addresses dynamically, you will not need
to change these settings.
Servers requiring assigned IP addresses may also need a way to map computer
names to IP addresses. The WORKABOUT PRO supports two name resolution
options: DNS and WINS.
Your ISP or network administrator can determine which name resolution you need,
and can also provide the server address. In addition, you will want to ask if alternate
addresses are available. An alternate address may allow you to connect when the
primary server is not available.
6.24 Setting Up A Network Card
Network (802.11b) cards are used to connect directly to a network. You’ll be able to
browse the Internet, download e-mail and so on. You do not need to create a new
connection on your WORKABOUT PRO.
Before you begin, make certain that your network card is inserted in the
WORKABOUT PRO.
1. Obtain the following information from your network administrator: user
name, password and domain name.
2. When the network card is inserted in your unit for the first time, the Network
Settings screen is displayed automatically so that you can configure the card.
If it does not appear, or if you want to change settings, tap on Start, Settings.
Tap on the Connections tab and then on the Network Cards icon.
164 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Changing Network Card Settings
3. If you need to specify server information, tap on the appropriate adaptor,
and then tap on the Name Servers tab.
Figure 6.71 Name Servers Screen
Note:
Because most networks use DHCP, you should not need to change these
settings unless instructed to do so by your network administrator.
4. If necessary, use a network cable to connect the network card to your network. Refer to your the documentation shipped with your network card for
details.
5. To activate the connection, launch the desired program (e.g., Internet
Explorer). The WORKABOUT PRO will connect automatically.
6.24.1 Changing Network Card Settings
If you use your network card in two locations like work and home, you’ll need to
change the network to which the network card connects.
1. Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab and then, on the
Network Cards icon.
2. In the drop-down menu below My network card connects to, choose either
The Internet or Work.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 165
Chapter 6: Settings
VPN Connection Setup
6.24.2 VPN Connection Setup
A VPN connection provides a secure connection to servers through the Internet.
Before you begin, you need the following information from your network
administrator: password, domain name, TCP/IP settings and a host name or IP
address of the VPN server.
1. Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the
Connections icon.
2. Under My Work Network, tap on Add a new VPN server connection.
3. In the Name field, type a name for this connection.
4. In Host name/IP, type the VPN server name or IP address.
5. In the VPN type drop-down menu, choose the type of authentication for your
WORKABOUT PRO: IPSec/L2TP or PPTP. Your network administrator
will let you know which option applies to your unit.
6. Tap on Next.
7. Choose the type of authentication in this screen. If you choose A pre-shared
key, type the key provided by your network administrator.
8. Tap on Next.
9. Type your user name, password and domain name. If a domain name was
not provided to you, try the connection without entering a domain name.
Note:
Normally, you will not need to change any advanced settings. You will
need to make changes only under only the following circumstances:
The server to which you are connecting does not dynamically assign
addresses, and TCP/IP settings need to be entered.
Server DNS or WINS settings need to be changed.
If you need to edit the Advanced settings, refer to “Advanced Modem Settings” on page 161 for details about this tab.
10. Tap on Finish.
11. Launch a program like Internet Explorer to activate the connection. The
VPN connection will start automatically.
166 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Managing An Existing Connection
6.24.3 Managing An Existing Connection
Once you’ve defined a connection, a new option appears in the first Connections
screen–Manage existing connections.
6.24.3.1 Editing A Connection
•
•
Tap on Settings, Connections tab. Tap on the Connections icon.
Tap on Manage existing connections.
Figure 6.72 Modem Screen
•
•
•
Note:
To edit your connection, tap on the Edit button. This will take you back to
the Connection screen where you can make any necessary changes.
To launch a connection from this screen, press and hold the stylus on the
connection you want to activate. Choose Connect from the pop-up menu.
To delete a connection, press and hold the stylus on the connection you
want to delete. Choose Delete from the pop-up menu.
You can also create a new connection using this screen. Tap on the New
button to begin.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 167
Chapter 6: Settings
Changing A Connection Setting Name
6.24.3.2 Changing A Connection Setting Name
Your WORKABOUT PRO has two sets of connection settings: My ISP and My
Work Network. If you want to change one or both of these options to something
more familiar to you, follow the steps that follow.
1. Tap on Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the Connections icon.
2. Under My Work Network or My ISP, tap on Manage existing connections.
3. Tap on the General tab.
Figure 6.73 General Tab
4. Type the name you prefer in the field below Enter a name for these settings.
5. Tap on OK.
168 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Selecting A Network
6.24.4 Selecting A Network
Important:
Normally, you will not need to change these settings. Contact your
ISP or network administrator before making any changes.
Private networks are used for work-related activities. Internet networks are used for
home connection to your ISP. The My Work Network settings are used for private
network connections (corporate networks), while My ISP settings are used for
Internet network connections.
When you use programs such as Messaging or Internet Explorer, your
WORKABOUT PRO automatically connects using private network settings under
My Work Network or Internet settings under My ISP, depending on specifications.
You can determine how your WORKABOUT PRO connects.
1. Tap Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the Connections
icon.
2. Tap on the Advanced tab.
Figure 6.74 Connections Advanced Tab
3. Tap on Select Networks.
4. In the appropriate lists, choose My ISP or My Work Network.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 169
Chapter 6: Settings
Ending A Connection
6.24.5 Ending A Connection
•
•
•
When connected through a modem or VPN connection, tap on the connec–in the menu bar, and then tap on Disconnect.
tivity icon–
When connected with a cable or cradle, detach the cable from your WORKBOUT PRO.
When connected through a network (Ethernet) card, remove the card from
the WORKABOUT PRO.
6.24.6 Proxy Server Setup
Note:
If you are connected to your ISP or private network during synchronization, the WORKABOUT PRO will download the appropriate settings during synchronization from your PC. If these settings are not on your PC, or
if they need to be changed, you’ll need to set up the proxy server connection manually.
To set up the proxy server connection manually, you’ll need the following
information: proxy server name, server type, port, type of Socks protocol used and
the user name and password.
1. Tap Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the Connections icon.
2. Under My Work Network, tap on Set up my proxy server.
Figure 6.75 Proxy Settings Tab
3. Add a checkmark next to This network connects to the Internet and This
network uses a proxy server to connect to the Internet.
170 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Changing Advanced Proxy Server Settings
4. In the Proxy server field, type the proxy server name.
5. Tap on OK to save your changes.
Note:
If you need to change advanced settings such as a port number or proxy
server type, you’ll need to tap on the Advanced button rather than tapping on OK. Advanced settings are described in “Changing Advanced
Proxy Server Settings” on page 171
6.24.6.1 Changing Advanced Proxy Server Settings
1. To change advanced settings such as port number or proxy server type, tap
on the Advanced button.
Figure 6.76 Advanced Proxy Server Screen
2. For the appropriate server type, type the proxy server name and port.
3. Choose Socks 4 or Socks 5.
4. If you choose Socks 5, tap on Socks 5 ID, and type the user name and password used to connect to your proxy server. Tap on OK.
6.24.7 Wireless Network Setup
Refer to Chapter 5: Connecting To A LAN With 802.11b beginning on page 69 for
details about setting up your wireless radio.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 171
Chapter 6: Settings
Bluetooth Setup
6.25 Bluetooth Setup
Bluetooth is a short-range wireless technology (approximately 10 meters) that
enables data communication between digital devices and is intended for Personal
Area Networks (PAN). It also provides the capability to use a Bluetooth-enabled
cellular phone as a data modem, exchanging information with other Bluetooth
devices and providing network access.
6.25.1 Bluetooth Mode
•
Tap Start, Settings. Tap on the Connections tab followed by the
Bluetooth icon.
Figure 6.77 Bluetooth Mode Tab
When Turn on Bluetooth is enabled (a checkmark is displayed in the checkbox),
Bluetooth features are available. If this option is disabled, you cannot send or
receive information using Bluetooth.
When Make this device discoverable to other devices is enabled, other Bluetooth
devices within range (approximately 10 meters) can detect your WORKABOUT
PRO and can establish a bond or use a Bluetooth service. If this option is enabled,
other devices can detect your unit whether or not a bond has been created.
172 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
Scanning For A New Device
6.25.2 Scanning For A New Device
Figure 6.78 Bluetooth Devices Tab
•
Tap on the Devices tab.
To add a new device:
•
Tap on New....
The WORKABOUT PRO scans for a Bluetooth device within a 10 meter range.
Any Bluetooth devices within range appear in the Bluetooth list box
Figure 6.79 Adding A Device
•
Highlight the device you want to add. Tap on Next.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 173
Chapter 6: Settings
Scanning For A New Device
Figure 6.80 Passkey (PIN) Screen
•
Type your passkey (PIN). Tap on Next.
Figure 6.81 Display Name
•
•
Note:
In the Display Name screen, edit the name of the device. This is optional.
Tap on Finish.
To connect to a Bluetooth-equipped device that’s already been added, tap
on the item in Bluetooth list box.
174 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 6: Settings
The Bluetooth GPRS Phone
6.25.3 The Bluetooth GPRS Phone
Once you’ve completed the Bluetooth settings, you can go ahead and set up
communication through your Bluetooth-equipped phone.
1. Before you begin, make certain that the Bluetooth phone is turned on, that
the Bluetooth radios in your WORKABOUT PRO and phone are enabled
(turned on), and that the hand-held and phone are within 10 metres of each
other. Both should be discoverable.
2. Tap on Start, Settings and then tap on the Connections tab.
3. Tap on the Connections icon. In the next screen, tap on Add a new modem
connection.
Figure 6.82 Make New Connection Screen
4. Type a name for the connection.
5. Tap on the Select a modem drop-down menu, and choose Bluetooth. Tap
on the Next button.
6. Make certain that the phone is discoverable. Some phones also need to be
pairable in order to accept a bonding request. Refer to your phone documentation for additional information.
7. If the phone appears in the My Connections list, skip to step 13.
8. In the list, tap the phone and then tap on the Next button.
9. In the PIN screen, type a personal identification number (PIN)–you can
enter up to 16 characters.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 175
Chapter 6: Settings
The Bluetooth GPRS Phone
10. Enter the same PIN on the phone.
11. If you wish, you can edit the name of the phone in the Name field.
12. Tap on the Finish button.
13. In the My Connections list, tap on the phone and then on the Next button.
14. Enter the dial-up phone number for this connection, and tap on the Next
button.
15. In the User name, Password and Domain fields, enter the logon information
for this connection, and tap on Finish.
You can begin using the Bluetooth phone connection, for example, to send and
receive e-mail, browse the Internet with Internet explorer, and so on.
176 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
7
PROGRAMS
7.1 Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2 ActiveSync® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.1 ActiveSync Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.2 Scheduling Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.2.3 Connecting To The Internet With ActiveSync . . . .
7.3 Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.4 Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5 Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.1 Adding Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.2 Importing Contacts From Other Programs . . . . . .
7.5.3 Creating Contact Categories . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.4 Assigning Contacts To Categories . . . . . . . . . .
7.5.5 Viewing Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.6 File Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7 Find . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.1 Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.2 Internet Explorer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.3 Browsing Web Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.4 The View Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.5 Changing Security Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.6 Changing Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.7 Organizing Favorite Web Sites . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.7.8 Synchronizing A Favorite Link. . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8 Messaging–The Inbox. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.1 Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.2 Synchronizing E-mail With Outlook . . . . . . . . .
7.8.3 Changing Synchronization Settings . . . . . . . . .
7.8.4 Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
7.8.5 Downloading Messages From A Remote Server . . .
7.8.6 Replying And Forwarding Messages . . . . . . . . .
7.8.7 Receiving Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.8 Creating And Sending A Message . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.9 Attaching A File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.181
.181
.182
.183
.183
.185
.185
.185
.186
.187
.187
.188
.188
.189
.189
.190
.190
.190
.191
.192
.193
.194
.196
.197
.197
.198
.199
.200
.203
.204
.205
.206
.206
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
177
Chapter 7: Programs
7.8.10 Deleting A Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.8.11 Storage Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9 MSN Messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.1 Setting Up Your MSN Account . . . . . . . . .
7.9.2 Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.3 Signing In To MSN Messenger . . . . . . . . .
7.9.4 Signing Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.5 Adding Contacts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.6 Deleting Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.9.7 Managing Your Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10 Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.1 Creating A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.2 Converting Notes To Text . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.3 Renaming A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.4 Recording Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.10.5 Synchronizing A Note . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11 Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.1 Moving Photos To The WORKBOUT PRO . .
7.11.2 Opening A Photo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.3 Deleting A Photo. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.4 Editing A Photo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.5 Creating A Slide Show. . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.6 Pocket Excel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.7 Workbook Components . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.11.8 Moving Between Worksheets . . . . . . . . .
7.11.9 Adding, Deleting And Renaming Worksheets .
7.11.10 Entering Data In A Worksheet . . . . . . . .
7.11.11 Working With Cells, Rows and Columns. . .
7.11.12 Creating Formulas . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12 Pocket Word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.1 Creating A New Document . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.2 Creating A New Document From A Template
7.12.3 Opening An Existing Document. . . . . . . .
7.12.4 Saving Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.5 Reverting To A Previously Saved Version. . .
7.12.6 Data Entry Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.7 Formatting Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.12.8 Sharing Documents With Your PC . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
178 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
206
207
208
208
208
209
210
210
211
211
212
213
213
215
215
216
217
218
218
219
219
221
222
223
223
224
224
226
231
235
236
236
237
238
238
239
241
245
Chapter 7: Programs
7.13 Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14 Terminal Services Client. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.1 Connecting To A Terminal Server. . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.2 Moving Around Terminal Services Client . . . . . .
7.14.3 Improving Display Performance . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.4 Improving Browser Performance . . . . . . . . . . .
7.14.5 Disconnecting Without Ending A Session . . . . . .
7.14.6 Ending A Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15 Windows Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.1 Converting A Media File On Your PC . . . . . . . .
7.15.2 Copying Music Files From A CD . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.3 Copying Music And Video Files To Your Hand-Held
7.15.4 Auto Syncing Music. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.5 Playing Music And Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7.15.6 Windows Media Player Controls . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.245
.245
.245
.246
.246
.247
.247
.247
.247
.247
.251
.253
.253
.255
.258
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 179
Chapter 7: Programs
Games
The Programs menu provides access to all the applications available on your
WORKABOUT PRO.
•
Tap on Start, Programs to display this screen.
Tapping on an icon in this screen launches the associated program.
Figure 7.1 Programs Tabs
7.1 Games
Your WORKABOUT PRO is equipped with a few standard games–Jawbreaker and
Solitaire–should you feel the need to pass the time.
7.2 ActiveSync
®
ActiveSync®–Microsoft PC connectivity software–can be used to connect the
WORKABOUT PRO to PCs running this software. By connecting the hand-held to a
PC through your desktop docking station and running ActiveSync on the PC, you can
view WORKABOUT PRO files, drag and drop files between the WORKABOUT
PRO and the PC, connect to the Internet, and so on.
ActiveSync can be installed from the Companion CD included with your
WORKABOUT PRO.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 181
Chapter 7: Programs
ActiveSync Options
7.2.1 ActiveSync Options
1. In the ActiveSync program on your PC, tap on Tools, Options to display the
Sync Options tab. The Sync Options tab is selected by default.
Figure 7.2 Sync Options Tab
2. Tap in the checkboxes to add a checkmark next to the types of information
you want ActiveSync to synchronize.
3. If your corporation has a Microsoft Exchange Server with Exchange Server
ActiveSync installed and you need to synchronize with it, tap in the checkbox next
to Enable synchronization with a server, and tap Configure to set it up.
Keep in mind that you can only synchronize items with one or the other–for
example, if you sync your Inbox with the server, you cannot sync it with
your PC.
182 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Scheduling Synchronization
7.2.2 Scheduling Synchronization
To choose when your data will be synchronized:
1. Tap on the Schedule tab in the Options dialog box.
Figure 7.3 Schedule Tab
2. Choose when you want ActiveSync to synchronize by tapping on the
drop-down menu next to When connected to my PC, sync. You can choose
Continuously, On Connection or Manually.
3. To synchronize with a server, choose how often by tapping on the
drop-down menu in the Server Schedule area.
4. In the Wireless Schedule area, tap on the drop-down menu to determine how
often ActiveSync will synchronize during the busiest e-mail traffic times and
slower e-mail times. Tap the Peak Times button to set up your peak times.
7.2.3 Connecting To The Internet With ActiveSync
If your computer is connected to the Internet and your WORKABOUT PRO is
connected to your computer with ActiveSync, then your WORKABOUT PRO is
connected to the Internet—provided that the ActiveSync Pass Through option
is enabled.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 183
Chapter 7: Programs
Connecting To The Internet With ActiveSync
To enable Pass Through in ActiveSync:
•
In ActiveSync on your PC, tap on the Options icon to display the Options
screen. Tap on the Rules tab.
Figure 7.4 ActiveSync Rules Tab
•
In the Pass Through section at the bottom of the screen, make certain that
the Connection drop-down menu is set to The Internet.
To connect to the Internet with ActiveSync:
•
•
•
Connect your PC to the Internet.
Connect your WORKABOUT PRO to your PC.
On your WORKABOUT PRO, check your connection by tapping Start,
Programs, ActiveSync to make certain it says Connected, or
On your PC, in the ActiveSync Details screen, make certain that it
says Connected.
184 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Calculator
.
Figure 7.5 ActiveSync Connected
Your WORKABOUT PRO is now connected to the Internet.
7.3 Calculator
Tapping on Start, Programs, Calculator displays a standard calculator with regular
functions.
•
Use your stylus to tap the calculator buttons.
7.4 Calendar
This option is used to map out all your upcoming appointments, meetings and so on
in the weeks, months and even years ahead.
Important:
Refer to “Calendar Of Upcoming Appointments” on page 52 for
details about this option.
7.5 Contacts
The Windows Mobile 2003 SE operating system is equipped with a Contacts
program that synchronizes with the Contacts module of the Outlook program on
your PC–so what you do on one happens to the other.
Note:
To synchronize Contacts using ActiveSync, refer to “ActiveSync Options”
on page 182 for details.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 185
Chapter 7: Programs
Adding Contacts
Contacts make it easy to e-mail anyone in your list. You’re not limited to e-mail
addresses–you can also create lists of friends’ home addresses and phone numbers,
and so on.
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Contacts, or
If Contacts is listed in your Start menu, tap on Start, Contacts.
Figure 7.6 Contacts Screen
7.5.1 Adding Contacts
•
Tap on New to display a New Contact screen.
Figure 7.7 New Contact Form
•
•
Type the information into the applicable fields for the contact you want to add.
Tap OK–your contact now appears on the Contacts screen.
186 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Importing Contacts From Other Programs
7.5.2 Importing Contacts From Other Programs
•
•
•
•
In Outlook on your PC, tap File, Import and Export... to display the
Import and Export Wizard.
Tap on Import from another program or file, and tap on Next.
Tap the type of file you want to import, and tap on Next.
Continue making the selections and tapping Next until you are finished, and
then tap Finish.
Your contacts are imported into Outlook and are ready to use.
7.5.3 Creating Contact Categories
Categories help you organize your contacts according to criteria you specify.
To create a category:
•
•
•
•
In the Contacts screen, tap the contact you wish to assign to a category.
The summary screen for the contact is displayed.
Tap on the Edit menu to display the Contacts editing screen.
Use the scroll bar to move down to the Categories field.
Tap the stylus on the Categories field to display your options. Tap on the
Add/Delete tab.
Figure 7.8 Add/Delete Tab
•
•
In the text box at the top of this screen, type the new category you want to
include.
Tap on Add.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 187
Chapter 7: Programs
Assigning Contacts To Categories
7.5.4 Assigning Contacts To Categories
In the Contacts screen:
•
•
•
•
•
Tap the contact you want to assign to a category. The Summary screen for
the contact is displayed.
Tap on the Edit menu to display the Contacts editing screen.
Use the scroll bar to move down to the Categories field. By default, contacts are assigned to No Categories.
Tap the Categories field to display the current category options.
Tap in the checkbox next to the category you want to put the contact into,
and tap OK.
The contact is assigned to the category you chose.
7.5.5 Viewing Contacts
The Show menu at the top of the Contacts screen lets you sort how you want to view
your contacts–Recent, All Contacts and No Categories.
•
•
Tap Start, Contacts.
Tap the All Contacts drop-down menu at the top-left corner of the Contacts screen.
Figure 7.9 Contacts Screen Show Menu
•
Tap a menu option to determine how you want the contacts to be displayed.
• Recent–displays a list of those contacts you access most recently.
• All Contacts–displays all your contacts.
• No Categories–displays contacts not assigned to a category.
188 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
File Explorer
7.6 File Explorer
Windows Mobile 2003 SE files are stored in folders and sub-folders that are
accessible through File Explorer. You can open, save, rename, copy and paste files
in the same manner as you would on any desktop PC.
Important:
Refer to “Managing Files And Folders” on page 57 for details
about this program.
7.7 Find
•
Tap Start, Programs, and then tap on the Find icon.
Figure 7.10 Find Screen
This screen allows you to search through the help files for a particular topic.
• In the Find field, type the item for which you’re looking.
• To narrow your search, tap on the Type drop-down menu and choose from a list
of preexisting programs. To search through all files, leave this option at All Data.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 189
Chapter 7: Programs
Help
7.7.1 Help
•
Tap on Start, Programs, and then tap on the Help icon.
Figure 7.11 Help Screen
•
Tap on the item in the Help list for which you require information.
7.7.2 Internet Explorer
You can connect to Internet Explorer in two ways: by connecting the WORKABOUT PRO directly to the Internet or by connecting through your PC while the
hand-held is attached via ActiveSync (see “ActiveSync®” on page 181).
7.7.3 Browsing Web Sites
There is little difference between the standard Internet Explorer found on your PC
and that found on your WORKABOUT PRO, sometimes referred to as Pocket
Internet Explorer. You can enter URLs, set a ‘home page’, turn images on and off,
e-mail links to friends, and so on.
To go to a web site:
• Connect your WORKABOUT PRO to the Internet. (Refer to “Connecting
To The Internet With ActiveSync” on page 183 for details.)
• Tap on Start, Programs, Internet Explorer to open Pocket Internet
Explorer.
• Tap on the address bar–the field near the top of the screen where URLs are
entered–to highlight the current URL.
• Type a new URL in the address bar.
190 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
The View Menu
7.7.4 The View Menu
Turning Images On And Off
•
•
Tap on Start, Program, Internet Explorer, and tap on the View menu.
Tap on Show Images to add or remove the check mark.
Figure 7.12 The View Menu
Fitting The Page To The Screen
You are provided with three layout options–One Column, Default and Desktop.
To choose a layout:
•
In the Pocket Internet screen, tap on View, Layout and then choose an
option.
Figure 7.13 Screen Layout Options
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 191
Chapter 7: Programs
Changing Security Options
One column–puts almost all Web page content into one column that is as
wide as the screen. You will not need to scroll horizontally.
Default–maintains a layout similar to that you’d see on your desktop computer. Most of the content is arranged so that you can see most of it without
needing to scroll horizontally.
Desktop–maintains the same layout and size as that on your PC. You’ll
need to scroll both horizontally and vertically.
7.7.5 Changing Security Options
Pocket Internet Explorer supports protocols used by Secure Sockets Layer (SSL). A
connection using SSL allows you to send personal information safely. To find out if
your connection uses this protocol:
•
In the Pocket Internet screen, tap on View, Properties.
Figure 7.14 Internet Explorer Properties Screen
192 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Changing Options
To change your security settings:
•
Tap on Tools, Options, Security tab.
Figure 7.15 Internet Explorer Security Tab
Cookies collect information about your identity and preferences so that a page can
tailor information to your needs. The page sends the file, and it is stored on your
WORKABOUT PRO. To stop the Pocket Internet Explorer from collecting cookies:
• Tap in the checkbox to the left of Allow cookies to disable this option.
• Tap on OK when you’ve completed your changes.
7.7.6 Changing Options
Freeing Storage Space
•
Tap on Tools, Options, Memory tab.
Figure 7.16 Internet Explorer Memory Tab
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 193
Chapter 7: Programs
Organizing Favorite Web Sites
To free storage:
•
•
Tap on Delete Files. All pages stored on your WORKABOUT
PRO–including offline favorites content–are deleted.
Tap on Clear History to delete all cached links.
Setting A Home Page And Changing Character Sets
To change your default Home page to the page you are currently viewing:
•
Tap on the General tab.
Figure 7.17 Internet Explorer General Tab
•
Tap on Use Current.
To change character sets to view text in a different language:
•
•
Tap on Tools, Options, and tap on the General tab.
Tap in the drop-down menu below Default character set, and choose the
character set that represents the language you want to view.
7.7.7 Organizing Favorite Web Sites
You can create a list of favorite web sites on your WORKABOUT PRO just as you
can on your PC. You can also transfer favorites from your PC.
The WORKABOUT PRO stores these in a special area called Mobile Favorites.
Viewing Mobile Favorites
•
Tap on Start, Internet Explorer.
194 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Organizing Favorite Web Sites
•
Tap on the Mobile Favorites icon at the base of the Explorer screen–
.
Figure 7.18 Favorites Screen
This screen shows your current favorite web sites. The WORKABOUT PRO lists a
few sites already in the list by default.
•
Tap on a favorite to open the website.
Adding Mobile Favorites
•
In Internet Explorer, open the web page you want to add to your favorites.
•
Tap on the Mobile Favorites icon–
•
Tap on the Add/Delete tab.
to display the Favorites screen.
Figure 7.19 Internet Explorer Add/Delete Tab
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 195
Chapter 7: Programs
Synchronizing A Favorite Link
•
Tap on Add... to display the Add Favorites screen. The fields are automatically completed with data from the web page that is currently loaded in the
WORKABOUT PRO Internet Explorer.
Figure 7.20 Add Favorites Screen
•
Note:
Tap on Add to add this web site to your Mobile Favorites.
To delete a web site from your list, in the Add/Delete tab (Figure 7.34 on
page 208), highlight the site you want to remove. Tap on <Delete>.
7.7.8 Synchronizing A Favorite Link
•
•
In Internet Explorer on your PC, go to the web site you want to add to your
Mobile Favorites.
Next, tap on Favorites, Add to Favorites... to display the Add Favorite
dialog box.
Figure 7.21 Add Favorite PC Screen
196 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Messaging–The Inbox
•
•
In the Create in list, tap on the Mobile Favorites folder to select it.
If you want to be able to view the site on your WORKABOUT PRO when
it is not connected, tap in the checkbox next to Make available offline to
enable it.
Note:
Making a site available offline allows you to read the web page at any
time on your hand-held without being connected to anything. Keep in
mind that all parts of the web page are added, including images. These
files can take up considerable memory so if memory is an issue, leave this
option disabled (unchecked).
•
Tap on OK.
The next time you synchronize using ActiveSync, the site will be added to your
WORKABOUT PRO Favorites.
7.8 Messaging–The Inbox
The Messaging program is used to send and receive e-mail on your WORKABOUT
PRO. To send and receive e-mail, you’ll need to synchronize your PC or connect to
a Post Office Protocol 3 (POP3) or Internet Message Access Protocol 4 (IMAP4)
mail server.
For each of these methods, you need to set up an e-mail account with one
exception–Outlook e-mail accounts are set up by default.
7.8.1 Folders
If you use an Outlook e-mail account, messages in the Inbox folder in Outlook are
automatically synchronized with your WORKABOUT PRO. You can use
ActiveSync on your PC to synchronize additional folders. The folders and messages
you move are mirrored on the server.
For POP3 accounts, if you move e-mail messages to a folder you create, the link
between the messages on the WORKABOUT PRO and the copies on the mail
server are broken. When you next connect, the mail server will recognize that the
messages are missing from the WORKABOUT PRO Inbox folder and delete them
from the server, preventing duplication of messages. Keep in mind however that you
will not have further access to messages that you moved to folders from anywhere
except with the hand-held.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 197
Chapter 7: Programs
Synchronizing E-mail With Outlook
For IMAP4 accounts, the folders you create and the messages you move are
reflected on the server, making messages available any time whether you connect to
your mail server from your WORKABOUT PRO or your PC.
7.8.2 Synchronizing E-mail With Outlook
By synchronizing the WORKABOUT PRO Messaging program with Outlook on
your PC, your e-mail is available on both the hand-held and on your PC.
Note:
•
Synchronizing e-mail does not require that the WORKABOUT PRO have
an independent connection to the Internet.
In ActiveSync on your PC, tap on the Options icon
the top of the screen.
in the tool bar at
Figure 7.22 Sync Options–PC Screen
•
Make certain that a check mark is displayed in the checkbox next to Inbox.
Tap on OK.
Once you check Inbox for synchronization, Outlook e-mail messages are
synchronized as part of the general synchronization process. The next time you
synchronize with ActiveSync, the e-mail in Outlook on your PC will be transferred
to the Messaging program on your WORKABOUT PRO.
198 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Changing Synchronization Settings
7.8.3 Changing Synchronization Settings
•
In ActiveSync on your PC, double-tap the Inbox item in the Sync Options tab.
Figure 7.23 Mail Synchronization PC Screen
•
•
•
•
•
Add a checkmark next to the folders in this screen that you want to synchronize with your WORKABOUT PRO.
To control the number of lines copied to the WORKABOUT PRO, put a
check mark next to To save space, copy at most and specify the maximum
number of lines of text.
To indicate how far back you want the WORKABOUT PRO to synchronize
e-mail, put a check mark next to Copy messages from the last and type the
number of days.
If you want to accept file attachments, add a check mark next to Include file
attachments. To limit the size, tap on Limit attachment size, and specify a
size in the KB box.
Tap on OK.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 199
Chapter 7: Programs
Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
7.8.4 Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
Creating An Account
•
In the Messaging screen taskbar, tap on the Accounts tab.
Figure 7.24 Messaging Account Screen
•
•
In the Messaging Options screen, tap on New..., and complete the fields in
the screens that are displayed.
Figure 7.25 E-mail Address Screen
Type your e-mail address–for example, [email protected]
200 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
•
Tap on Next.
Figure 7.26 E-mail Auto Configuration Screen
Auto configuration attempts to connect to your e-mail server and download
necessary settings so that you do not need to enter them manually.
If Auto Configuration is successful, you may begin downloading messages from
the server.
If Auto configuration is not successful, you’ll need to continue with the New
Account wizard screens. You’ll need the following information.
• Account type.
• POP3 or IMAP4 server name.
• Domain name (for network connections only).
• Tap Next.
Figure 7.27 User Information Screen
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 201
Chapter 7: Programs
Mail Server Accounts–Creating, Editing & Deleting
•
Type your name and password in the fields provided. Tap Next.
Figure 7.28 Account Information Screen
•
•
•
In the Account type drop-down menu, choose the appropriate protocol.
POP3 is the most common protocol.
In the Name field, type a unique name for this account such as Work or
Home. Keep in mind that this cannot be changed at a later date.
Tap Next.
Figure 7.29 Server Information
•
•
In the Incoming mail field, type the name of your e-mail server.
In the Outgoing mail field, type the name of your Simple Mail Transfer
Protocol (SMTP).
202 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Downloading Messages From A Remote Server
•
•
If you are using a network connection, type your domain name in the
Domain field.
Tap Finish when you’ve completed all fields.
Editing An Account
•
•
In the Messaging screen taskbar, tap on the Accounts menu. Choose the
Accounts command.
In the Accounts screen, tap on the account you want to edit. Complete the
fields in the screens that are displayed.
Deleting An Account
•
•
In the Messaging screen taskbar, tap on the Accounts menu. Choose the
Accounts command.
Tap and hold the stylus until a pop-up menu is displayed. Choose Delete.
7.8.5 Downloading Messages From A Remote Server
Note:
If you receive your e-mail messages through ActiveSync, just begin synchronization. No other steps are required to download messages. The steps in
this section outline how to download messages from a remote server.
•
•
•
In the Messaging screen, tap Accounts>Connect to open a connection.
Tap Accounts. Ensure that the account you choose is marked with a bullet.
Tap Connect.
When you tap on Connect, the messages in your WORKABOUT PRO and
e-mail server are synchronized.
Tap on a message in the message list to open it.
If you decide that you need a complete copy of the message, tap Edit,
Mark for Download while the message window is open, or
In the message list (with the message closed), tap and hold the stylus on the
message you want to download. In the pop-up menu, choose Mark for
Download.
Tap Accounts, Disconnect when you’re finished.
•
•
•
•
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 203
Chapter 7: Programs
Replying And Forwarding Messages
7.8.6 Replying And Forwarding Messages
•
Open the message in the Inbox.
When you open a message in the Inbox, the tools used to work with the messages
are displayed in the taskbar along the bottom of the screen.
Tap on this icon to reply
to the message.
Figure 7.30 Replying To A Message
•
•
•
•
Tap on this icon
in the taskbar to display a pop-up menu. Choose the
appropriate command–Forward, Reply All, or Reply.
In the Reply screen, type your response.
To check the spelling in your response, tap on the Tools menu and choose
Spell Check.
When you’re done, tap on the Send button in the upper-left corner of the
response screen.
204 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Receiving Attachments
7.8.7 Receiving Attachments
An e-mail attachment or one downloaded from a server appears as an icon at the
bottom of the message.
Attachments window
Figure 7.31 Attachments
When you tap on the attachment icon, it opens provided it has been fully
downloaded.
Note:
If you are using an IMAP4 account, you can mark an attachment to be
downloaded the next time you connect.
If you receive messages through synchronization:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Launch ActiveSync on your PC.
Tap on File, Mobile Device, and then choose your mobile device.
Tap on Tools, and choose Options.
Choose the message account, choose Settings, and then choose Include
File Attachments.
5. If you’re receiving messages through a remote e-mail server and are using an
IMAP4 account:
In Messaging on your WORKABOUT PRO, tap on Accounts, Accounts,
and then choose IMAP4.
Tap on the Next button until you the Server Information screen is displayed.
Tap on Options.
Tap on Next twice, and then choose Get full copy of messages and When
getting full copy, get attachments.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 205
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating And Sending A Message
7.8.8 Creating And Sending A Message
1. In the inbox message list, tap on the Accounts menu, and choose Outlook
E-mail or the e-mail account you prefer.
2. In the taskbar at the bottom of the screen, tap on New.
Figure 7.32 Creating A Message
3. In the To field, type the e-mail address of the recipient(s) to which you are
sending the message, separating each with a semi-colon.
4. To access addresses from your Contacts list, tap the stylus on the To field.
5. Type a Subject and then type your message in the body of the screen.
6. To check your spelling, tap on Tools, Spell Check.
7. When you’re done, tap on the Send button in the upper-left corner of the
screen.
7.8.9 Attaching A File
1. With the message you’ve composed open, tap on the Tools menu and then
choose Add Attachment.
2. Choose the file you want to attach.
Note:
OLE objects cannot be attached to messages.
7.8.10 Deleting A Message
•
In the message list, tap and hold the stylus on the message you want to
delete. In the pop-up menu, choose Delete.
206 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Storage Options
If you want to select more than one message:
•
•
Tap and drag the stylus across the messages you want to delete.
Tap and hold the stylus on the selected messages. In the pop-up menu,
choose Delete.
Messages are moved into the Deleted Items folder.
7.8.11 Storage Options
To save memory, you can specify where you want attachments stored and when
items will be permanently deleted from the WORKABOUT PRO.
•
In the message list (Inbox), tap on Tools, Options, and then tap on the
Storage tab.
Figure 7.33 Messaging Storage Tab
Storing Attachments
To store attachments on a storage card rather than internal RAM:
•
Tap on the checkbox next to Store attachments on storage card.
Removing Deleted Items
To specify when items in the Deleted Items folder are permanently removed:
• Tap on the drop-down menu below Empty deleted items.
• Choose how you want items deleted.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 207
Chapter 7: Programs
MSN Messenger
7.9 MSN Messenger
MSN Messenger allows you to chat with friends and coworkers who use MSN
Messenger or Windows Messenger.
7.9.1 Setting Up Your MSN Account
To use MSN Messenger, you’ll need an Internet connection and a .NET Passport
account to log into MSN’s messaging servers.
Note:
MSN and Hotmail e-mail addresses are valid Passports accounts.
1. Set up a connection on your mobile device such as a modem or wireless connection. Refer to “Connections” beginning on page 158 for details.
2. Set up an MSN account.
To set up an MSN account, go to http://www.passport.com.
To set up a hotmail account, go to http://www.hotmail.com.
3. Once you’ve set up your account, you’re ready to use MSN Messenger.
7.9.2 Getting Started
1. Tap Start, Programs, and then tap on the MSN Messenger icon.
Figure 7.34 Startup MSN Messenger Screen
208 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Signing In To MSN Messenger
2. Tap on the Tools menu, and choose Options. Tap on the Accounts tab.
Figure 7.35 MSN Messenger Accounts Tab
3. Enable (add a checkmark) to Enable MSN Messenger Service and/or
Enable Exchange Instant Messaging.
4. If you enabled both accounts, tap on the Settings button and choose which
account to sign in to first.
5. Tap on OK.
7.9.3 Signing In To MSN Messenger
1. Tap on Start, Programs, MSN Messenger icon. Tap anywhere in the MSN
Messenger startup screen.
Figure 7.36 MSN Messenger Sign In Screen
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 209
Chapter 7: Programs
Signing Out
2. In the field below Sign in name, type your MSN .NET (or Hotmail)
e-mail account.
3. In the Password field, type your MSN.NET Passport password, and tap Sign in.
7.9.4 Signing Out
•
Tap on the Tools menu. Choose Sign Out.
7.9.5 Adding Contacts
The people you plan to chat with are known as your contacts in MSN Messenger.
Important:
These contacts are not to be confused with those identified in
Contacts program described beginning on page 185.
MSN Messenger contacts are stored on MSN’s servers, not on
your device–you cannot view them unless you’re online and
signed in. Contacts created in the Contracts program are synchronized with Outlook’s Contacts module.
You cannot send an instant message to someone until you’ve added that person as a
contact in MSN Messenger.
To add a contact:
1. Sign in to MSN Messenger on your WORKABOUT PRO.
2. Tap on Tools, Add a Contact.
Figure 7.37 Add A Contact Screen
3. In the Sign-in Name field, enter the contact’s full Passport (or Exchange)
e-mail address.
210 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Deleting Contacts
4. Tap on Next.
You’ll see a “Success!” message. A failure message is displayed if you mistyped the
e-mail address or if your contact doesn’t have a valid Passport account.
5. Tap OK.
Your contact is listed on the main MSN Messenger screen whenever you sign in to
the service.
7.9.6 Deleting Contacts
1. After signing in, in the main MSN Messenger screen, press and hold the tip
of the stylus on the contact’s name.
2. In the pop-up menu, choose Delete Contact.
3. In the screen warning you that you’re about to delete a contact permanently,
tap on Yes.
7.9.7 Managing Your Privacy
Blocking And Unblocking A Contact
To block a contact:
1. In the startup MSN Messenger screen, press and hold the stylus on a contact’s name.
2. Choose Block in the pop-up menu.
On the MSN Messenger start screen, you’ll see a red slash through the icon next to
this contact’s name. Blocked contacts do not know they’ve been blocked. To them,
your status will always be ‘not online’.
To unblock a contact:
1. In the startup MSN Messenger screen, press and hold the stylus on a contact’s name.
2. Choose Unblock in the pop-up menu.
Contact Notification
If you want to be notified when someone has added you to their contact list:
1. In the startup MSN Messenger screen, tap on Tools, Options, Privacy tab.
2. Check the box marked Alert me when I am added to a Passport contact list.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 211
Chapter 7: Programs
Notes
When someone adds you to their contact list, a dialog box appears on your WORKABOUT PRO that allows you to block them immediately should you choose.
Changing Your Status
To change your status:
1. Tap on Tools, My Status.
Figure 7.38 My Status Menu
2. When you’re signed in but unable (or unwilling) to reply to messages,
choose a status such as Away or Busy.
3. Choose Appear Offline if you want to see your contacts even though it will
appear to them that you’re not signed in.
7.10 Notes
The Notes application is an electronic notepad you can use to jot down your ideas
quickly. You can enter text using the soft keyboard, the WORKABOUT PRO
keyboard, or you can write on the screen using your stylus. You can also record a
message.
Notes can also be shared through e-mail and synchronization with your PC.
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Note launch this application, or
In the Today screen, tap on the New menu in the taskbar, and choose Note.
212 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating A Note
Figure 7.39 Notes Screen
7.10.1 Creating A Note
1. Choose an entry mode for your note.
To enter text with the soft keyboard, Transcriber or the Block or Letter Recognizer, tap the stylus on the soft keyboard icon
to choose your text
input method.
To use your stylus to handwrite on the screen, tap on the pen icon
.
Lines will be displayed on the Notes screen as guides.
Important: Refer to “Entering Text” on page 63 for details about these
options.
2. Compose your note using the method you’ve chosen.
3. Tap on OK when you’re done.
Your note is automatically saved. The file name is the first line of the note if
you used the keyboard–otherwise, it’s named Note1, Note2 and so on.
7.10.2 Converting Notes To Text
When you use the pen tool, you can write notes in your own handwriting and keep
them as is, if you like. You can also teach the WORKABOUT PRO to recognize
your handwriting and convert it into printed text.
To convert handwriting into text:
1. Tap on the pen tool
and compose a note using your stylus.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 213
Chapter 7: Programs
Converting Notes To Text
Figure 7.40 Handwriting A Note
2. Tap on Tools, Recognize.
The text in the note is converted from handwritten to printed text.
Figure 7.41 Converting Handwriting Into Print
Note:
To convert only a specific portion of your handwritten note into printed
type, tap the stylus just before the first letter of the text, pause for a second, and then drag your stylus across the text you want to select. Then,
tap on Tools, Recognize to convert only the highlighted text.
214 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Renaming A Note
Failed Conversions
The Recognize tool sometimes gets the conversion wrong. If some words are not
converted properly:
1. Press and hold the stylus on the incorrectly converted word.
2. In the pop-up menu, choose Alternative to display a list of possible alternatives to the incorrectly converted word. Your handwritten version is displayed along the top of the menu.
Figure 7.42 Incorrect Conversions
3. Tap on the correct word in the list.
4. If the word is not listed, as is the case in the sample screen, tap on the soft
keyboard icon
to display the soft keyboard, and type the correct word.
7.10.3 Renaming A Note
1. Press and hold the stylus on the file name in the Notes screen that you want
to rename. In the pop-up menu, choose Rename/Move, or
Tap the file name to select it, and tap on Tools, Rename/Move.
2. In the Name field, type the name you want to assign to the file, and tap OK.
7.10.4 Recording Notes
It’s sometimes easier to record a note than to write it down just to make certain that
you’ve captured an idea before it drifts away. To make an audio recording:
1. Open a new Note.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 215
Chapter 7: Programs
Synchronizing A Note
2. Tap on the recording icon
the bottom of the note.
to display the Record/Playback toolbar at
Volume
Skip to end
Skip to beginning
Record
Stop
Play
Progress
Indicator
3.
Figure 7.43 Recording Screen
Tap on the Record button–a beep alerts you that your device is now ready to
record.
4. Begin speaking into the microphone on the WORKABOUT PRO, or move
the hand-held to within a few feet of the source of the sound you want to
record.
5. Tap on the Stop button when you’ve completed your recording.
6. Tap on OK to save the note.
A speaker icon is displayed in the note indicating the presence of a recording within
the note.
Figure 7.44 Recorded Note
•
To play the recorded note, tap on the speaker icon.
7.10.5 Synchronizing A Note
Like Messaging, Tasks, Contacts and so on, the Notes program can be synchronized
with Outlook on your PC. In this way, all notes, recordings and drawings created in the
Notes program are copied to your PC and can be edited in Outlook’s Notes module.
216 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Pictures
To synchronize Notes with Outlook:
1. Connect your WORKABOUT PRO to your PC.
2. In the ActiveSync screen on your PC, tap on the Options icon
display the Options tab.
to
Figure 7.45 PC Sync Options Tab
3. Make certain that Notes is selected in this tab, and tap on OK.
When you next synchronize your WORKABOUT PRO with ActiveSync, all your
notes are copied to your PC.
7.11 Pictures
Pictures is a photo viewing program. This program also provides a number of tools
that allow you to crop, adjust picture contrast and brightness, zoom in and out of
photos and save your adjustments.
Important:
The Pictures program can only display .bmp or .jpg formats.
Photos in other formats will need to be converted on your PC
before they are transferred to the WORKABOUT PRO.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 217
Chapter 7: Programs
Moving Photos To The WORKBOUT PRO
7.11.1 Moving Photos To The WORKBOUT PRO
1. Connect your device to your PC with ActiveSync.
2. On your PC, using Windows Explorer (right-click My Computer and click
on Explorer), drag photos from their folder to the Mobile Device, My Pictures folder.
7.11.2 Opening A Photo
1. Tap on Start, Program, Pictures. You’ll see a thumbnail of your photos.
Pocket PC icon
Storage card icon
Slide Show icon
Figure 7.46 Pictures Thumbnail Photo
Note:
If you’ve stored your photos on a storage card, you’ll need to tap on the
storage card icon to display your photos.
2. Tap on a thumbnail to open a photo.
Figure 7.47 Viewing A Photo
218 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Deleting A Photo
7.11.3 Deleting A Photo
1. Press and hold the stylus on the photo you want to delete to display a pop-up
menu. Tap on Delete.
2. Confirm your choice when prompted.
7.11.4 Editing A Photo
•
Tap a thumbnail photo to open it.
To display the editing tools:
• Tap Edit, Brightness and Contrast. A new set of tools is displayed
above the taskbar.
Down Brightness
Up Brightness
Down Contrast
Up Contrast
Rotate
Crop
Magnify
Figure 7.48 Editing Photos
Adjusting Contrast And Brightness
•
•
•
•
Tap the Up Contrast icon or the Down Contrast icon to increase or
decrease the photo contrast.
Tap the Up Brightness icon or the Down Brightness icon to increase or
decrease the photo brightness.
Tap on the Rotate icon to flip the photo.
Tap OK when you’re done, and tap on Yes, No or Cancel when prompted.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 219
Chapter 7: Programs
Editing A Photo
Cropping A Photo
•
•
Tap on the Crop icon and then drag the stylus diagonally across the screen
to select the area of the image you want to crop.
Tap inside the box when prompted. Your photo is cropped.
Zooming In And Out
• Tap the Magnify icon–a smaller version of the photo is displayed on the screen.
Tap to arrange best fit
Tap to zoom in
Tap to zoom out
Figure 7.49 Zooming Photos
•
•
•
•
Tap on the Zoom In icon to zoom in and the Zoom Out icon to zoom out.
To bring a particular portion of the photo into view, press and hold the
stylus inside the red box. Drag it to bring a segment of the photo into view
on the WORKABOUT PRO screen.
Tap on the Best Fit icon to display the entire photo as large as possible
within the screen again.
Tap on Done when you have finished your adjustments, or
Tap on Cancel to discard your changes.
Once you’ve finished your edits:
•
Note:
Tap on OK to close the image. You’ll be asked if you want to save the
changes. Tap on Yes, No or Cancel.
Tapping on Yes overwrites the original version of the photo.
Keep in mind also that resaving a .jpg photo can result in loss of quality. It’s
better to tap on Cancel, then tap on Tools, Save Picture As, and type a new
name for the photo.
220 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating A Slide Show
7.11.5 Creating A Slide Show
To view a slide show:
•
Tap on the Slide Show icon
in the taskbar.
The slide show begins–in slide show mode, photos are displayed for about five
seconds, one after the other.
To display the slide show tool bar:
•
Tap anywhere on the photo.
Pause
Play
Flip View
Previous
Next
Close
Figure 7.50 Slide Show Bar
Flip View Button–switches between landscape and portrait.
Play Button–resumes playing the slide show if you’ve paused it.
Pause Button–pauses slide show.
Previous Button–returns to the previous screen.
Next Button–skips to the next photo.
Close Button–shuts down the slide show and returns to the main
Pictures screen.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 221
Chapter 7: Programs
Pocket Excel
7.11.6 Pocket Excel
Pocket Excel is an abridged version of Microsoft Excel, an electronic spreadsheet
program. In addition to providing the tools to manipulate text and numeric values
like statistics, percentages, using formulas that perform calculations, and so on, this
program can also include graphics such as pie charts.
Pocket Excel allows you to copy Excel workbooks from your PC onto your
WORKABOUT PRO and update them while you’re away from your desk.
When you synchronize your WORKABOUT PRO with your PC, the file–a Pocket
Excel workbook with a .pxl extension–is converted into a Microsoft Excel
workbook with an .xls extension, and visa versa.
To launch Pocket Excel:
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Pocket Excel. A blank workbook is displayed.
Figure 7.51 Pocket Excel Workbook
•
•
If a list of workbooks is displayed rather than a new sheet, you’ll need to
create a new workbook. To create a workbook:
In Pocket Excel, tap the New menu, or
In the Today screen, tap on the New menu, and then tap on
Excel Workbook.
222 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Workbook Components
7.11.7 Workbook Components
To better understand the components of a workbook, review the diagram below.
Columns
Address of selected text
Entry bar
Cell
Rows
Selected cell
Status bar
Toolbar
Menu bar
Formula drop-down menu
Sheet1 drop-down menu
Figure 7.52 Excel Components
•
If the toolbar is not visible, tap on the Show/Hide Toolbar icon
Format
Cells
Align
Left Align
Centre
Currency
Style
Align
Right
AutoSum
.
Decimal
Comma
Style
Zoom
Show/Hide Toolbar icon
Figure 7.53 Pocket Excel Toolbar
By default, a new workbook has three worksheets in it. Each worksheet has 256
columns and 16,384 rows.
7.11.8 Moving Between Worksheets
To move between worksheets:
•
Tap on the Sheet1 drop-down menu, and choose a worksheet.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 223
Chapter 7: Programs
Adding, Deleting And Renaming Worksheets
7.11.9 Adding, Deleting And Renaming Worksheets
To add, remove or rename a worksheet from within a workbook:
•
Tap on Formats, Modify Sheets.
Figure 7.54 Modify Sheets
•
•
Tap on the sheet you want to modify in the left column.
Tap Rename to assign a new name, Insert to add a new worksheet, Delete
to remove the worksheet, and Move Up or Move Down to change the order
of the worksheets.
7.11.10 Entering Data In A Worksheet
•
Tap on the cell in which you want to type text or numbers. A border appears
around the cell.
224 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Entering Data In A Worksheet
•
Begin typing text or numbers. As you type, a blinking cursor is displayed in
the entry bar at the top of the screen. This is where the data appears before it
is placed in a cell.
The data you type appears in the ‘entry bar’
before being placed in the ‘selected cell’.
Entry bar
Selected cell
Figure 7.55 Entering Data
•
Tap the check mark to the left of the entry bar, or tap on <Enter> on the soft
keyboard to place the data into the cell.
Cancelling An Entry
•
Tap on the ‘x’ button to the left of the entry bar.
Editing Cell Text Or Numbers
•
Tap at the end of the data in the entry bar, and then change the text using the
text entry method you prefer–soft keyboard, WORKABOUT PRO keyboard, and so on.
Entering Symbols
To enter symbols like hatch symbol (#) or to change the character set:
•
•
•
Tap on Tools, Insert Symbol.
In the Font drop-down menu, choose the font you would prefer to use.
In the Subset drop-down menu, choose the character set you’d like to use.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 225
Chapter 7: Programs
Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Copying And Pasting
•
•
•
•
Tap the cell that contains the data you want to copy.
Tap on Edit, Copy from the menu in the taskbar, or
Tap and hold the stylus in the cell you want to copy. In the pop-up menu,
choose Copy.
Tap in the cell where you want to paste the data.
Tap on Edit, Paste, or
Tap and hold the stylus in the cell where you want to paste the data. In the
pop-up menu, choose Paste.
7.11.11 Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Excel offers a number of formatting and editing tools to help you create a professional and accurate spreadsheet.
Formatting Cells
•
•
•
Tap on the cell you want to format, or select a group of cells by dragging the
stylus across them.
Tap on Format, Cells.
In the tabs at the bottom of the screen, choose the specific cell characteristics you want.
Figure 7.56 Format Cells Size Tab
Size Tab–Cell height ranges from 0 to 409. Cell width ranges from 0 to 255.
Decimals are acceptable for both height and width.
226 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Figure 7.57 Format Cells Number Tab
Number Tab–Numbers can represent currency, a date, a percentage, and so
on. The Category: drop-down menu allows you to choose what the number in
a spreadsheet represents. For example, choose Currency for monetary units.
Other categories have options attached to them. For example, tapping on
Time in the Category: drop-down menu displays a secondary window–Type–where you can choose how you want time represented in
the spreadsheet.
Figure 7.58 Additional Options
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 227
Chapter 7: Programs
Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Align Tab–The drop-down menus below the ‘Horizontal:’ and ‘Vertical:’
options allow you to arrange text in the cells. Tapping in the checkbox next
to ‘Wrap text’ wraps lines of text to fit in a cell.
Figure 7.59 Cell Alignment Tab
Font–The options in this tab allow you to choose a font, the colour and size
of the font, along with the style–Bold, Italic and Underline.
Figure 7.60 Font Tab
228 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Borders–This tab determines the appearance of a cell–the colour of cell borders, on which side of the cell borders will be displayed and any cell shading.
Figure 7.61 Borders Tab
•
When you’ve set your formatting options, tap on OK.
The cell you selected reflects the formatting you specified.
Inserting Rows And Columns
To insert a cell, row or column:
•
•
Tap a cell in the workbook next to which you want to insert a cell, row or
column.
Tap Format, Insert Cells..., or
Tap and hold the stylus on a cell. In the pop-up menu, choose Insert. The
Insert Cells screen appears.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 229
Chapter 7: Programs
Working With Cells, Rows and Columns
Figure 7.62 Insert Cells Screen
•
Tap in one of the radio buttons:
Shift cells right–inserts the cell to the left of the selected cell, and shifts
existing information to the right.
Shift cells down–inserts a cell above the selected cell, and shifts the existing cells down.
Entire row–inserts an entire row above the selected cell.
Entire column–inserts an entire column to the left of the selected cell.
Deleting Cells, Rows And Columns
•
•
Tap a cell that you want to delete, or if you want to delete an entire row or
column, tap on a cell in the row or column you want to delete.
Tap on Format, Delete Cells, or
Press and hold the stylus on a cell, and tap on Delete in the pop-up menu.
230 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating Formulas
Figure 7.63 Delete Cells
Shift cells left–deletes the selected cell and shifts existing information to the left.
Shift cells up–deletes the selected cell and shifts existing information up.
Entire row–deletes an entire row and shifts existing information up.
Entire column–deletes an entire column and shifts existing information to the left.
7.11.12 Creating Formulas
A formula is an equation beginning with an = sign that performs operations on your
data. The operations can be mathematical and can use numbers, text or cell
addresses.
You can enter formulas manually, or you can use the Insert Function command that
lists a collection of standard formulas.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 231
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating Formulas
Inserting Formulas Manually
In this example, the total expense
will appear in the selected cell,
next to ‘Total’.
Figure 7.64 Manually Entered Formulas
•
•
Tap the stylus in the cell where you want the result of the formula to appear.
Tap the stylus in the entry bar, and begin the formula by typing an
equal sign ‘=’.
Figure 7.65 Beginning A Formula
In the example above, the objective is to add the expenses together, placing the total
in the cell next to ‘Total’.
•
Tap the stylus in cell B1–the cell containing the value, 100–the value ‘B1’
appears in the entry bar.
232 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating Formulas
•
•
•
Since in this example, we want to add values together, tap the stylus on the
plus sign ‘+’ in the soft keyboard–tap the <CAPS> key in the soft keyboard
to display this symbol.
Tap the stylus in cell B2–the cell containing the value, 200.
Tap on the check mark icon to the left of the entry bar. The total of cells B1
and B2 are displayed in the cell that you selected at the outset.
Figure 7.66 Formula Results
Note:
Formulas are automatically recalculated whenever any changes are made
to the cells where the formula is applied.
Using The Insert Function Command
•
•
Tap the cell in which you want the result of the formula to appear.
To display the Insert Function screen, tap on Tools, Insert Function, or
Tap on the fx button to the left of the entry bar. (If this button is not visible,
tap the stylus in the entry bar.)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 233
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating Formulas
•
Figure 7.67 Insert Function Screen
Tap on the formula you want to use–for this example, the SUM formula
was used–‘SUM(number1,number2,...)’, and tap on OK.
Important:
The formula is displayed in the entry bar of the worksheet. This
formula is a model. The information in the parentheses must be
replaced by your data.
Figure 7.68 Inserting A Function
In this example, in the parentheses, the SUM function sample indicates that numbers
(or cell coordinates) be separated by commas.
•
In the entry bar, delete the example information in the parentheses–in this
example, (number1,number2...).
234 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Pocket Word
•
•
•
With the cursor positioned between the parentheses, tap the stylus on the
first cell you want to include in this formula, and then type a comma.
Tap the stylus on the next cell you want included in the formula, remembering to separate each entry with a comma.
When you’re done, tap on the check mark to the left of the entry bar.
The formula is calculated and the total is entered in the cell you selected at the outset.
Figure 7.69 Completed Formula
7.12 Pocket Word
If you’ve used Microsoft Word on your Mac or PC, Pocket Word will be familiar to
you. Keep in mind however that Pocket Word was designed for a small screen and
limited memory.
The first noticeable difference is the file format of the documents–Pocket Word
documents have a .psw extension rather than the Microsoft Word extension .doc.
During file transfer, files are converted automatically when transferred between
your PC and the WORKABOUT PRO.
Keep in mind, however, that a Word document created on your PC can lose key
formatting features such as styles and tables if you make changes to it on your
WORKABOUT PRO.
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Pocket Word.
When you initially open Word, a blank page is displayed. If you’ve already create a
Pocket Word document, a list of files is displayed.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 235
Chapter 7: Programs
Creating A New Document
7.12.1 Creating A New Document
•
In Pocket Word, tap on New in the taskbar at the bottom of the screen, or
In the Today screen, tap on the New menu, and choose Word Document
from the menu.
Figure 7.70 Pocket Word Document
7.12.2 Creating A New Document From A Template
•
In Pocket Word, tap on Tools, Options to display the Options screen.
Figure 7.71 Pocket Word Options Screen
Pocket Word provides five templates: Blank Document, Meeting Notes, Memo,
Phone Memo, and To Do.
236 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Opening An Existing Document
•
•
Once you’ve chosen a template, tap on OK.
Tap the New menu in the bottom-left corner of the screen.
The new document is displayed with the template format you chose–in this
example, the Memo template.
Figure 7.72 Template Word Document
Note:
Once you choose a template, each time you open a new document, it will
be presented in the template you chose. Follow the steps under “Creating
A New Document From A Template” on page 236 to switch back to the
default, Blank Document template, or another template.
7.12.3 Opening An Existing Document
•
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Pocket Word.
Tap on a document in the list to open it.
Figure 7.73 Pocket Word Document List
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 237
Chapter 7: Programs
Saving Documents
7.12.4 Saving Documents
•
Within a document, tap Tools, File, Save Document As.
Figure 7.74 Save Document As Screen
You can use this screen to change the following: the document name, folder
location, document type, storage location.
•
Note:
Once you’ve made your selections, tap OK to save your document.
A few points to keep in mind–If you choose None for the Folder: option,
your document is filed in My Documents by default.
If you aren’t planning to e-mail your document, keep it in the default format
because ActiveSync will convert it to a .doc file when you synchronize with
your PC.
If you are planning to e-mail your document, save it as a Rich Text Document (.rtf), Plain Text Document (.txt) or one of the Word Document (.doc)
formats to ensure that the file can be opened and read without difficulties.
7.12.5 Reverting To A Previously Saved Version
Important:
•
•
You cannot undo the Revert To Saved command–think carefully
before you choose this option.
Before closing a document, tap on Tools, File, Revert to Saved.
You will be prompted to verify that you do indeed want to undo all document changes. Tap on Yes.
238 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Data Entry Modes
Your document remains on the screen, but all changes you’ve made since opening
the document are reversed.
7.12.6 Data Entry Modes
Pocket Word offers a variety of data entry modes: Keyboard, Writing and
Recording.
Typing Modes
•
•
•
Note:
Open a Word document.
If the soft keyboard is not displayed, tap on the keyboard icon
lower-right corner of the taskbar.
Use your stylus to tap on the soft keyboard keys.
in the
In addition to the soft keyboard, you can enter text using Block Recognizer, Letter Recognizer or Transcriber. Refer to “Entering Text” on
page 63 for details.
You can also use the WORKABOUT PRO keyboard for data entry.
Handwriting Mode
•
•
In a Word document, tap View, Writing.
Using your stylus, write as clearly as you can, using the ruled lines on the
screen as a guide.
To convert the handwritten words into printed text:
•
Tap on Tools, Recognize.
Chances are there will be some recognition mistakes. To correct recognition errors:
•
Press and hold the stylus on the incorrectly converted word. In the pop-up
menu, choose Alternates.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 239
Chapter 7: Programs
Data Entry Modes
Figure 7.75 Alternate Conversions
•
•
Tap on the correct word in the list.
If the word is not listed, tap on the soft keyboard icon
soft keyboard, and type the correct word.
to display the
Recording Mode
To record a voice annotation:
•
Tap on View, Recording.
Volume
Skip to end
Skip to beginning
Record
Stop
Play
Progress
Indicator
Figure 7.76 Pocket Word Recording Toolbar
•
•
In the toolbar that appears at the bottom of the document, tap on the red
Record button in the far left corner.
Speak into the microphone to create your recording.
240 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Formatting Text
•
To stop the recording, tap on the black square Stop button in the toolbar.
To play a voice recording:
•
Tap your stylus on the speaker icon in the Pocket Word document.
Figure 7.77 Speaker Icon
7.12.7 Formatting Text
Using the Pocket Word Toolbar
Formats
Left
Italics
Align Centre Right Bullets
Align
Bold
Underline
Tap this icon to show
or hide this toolbar.
Figure 7.78 Pocket Word Toolbar
Note:
The
icon in the toolbar provides access to the same screen of formatting options that is presented when you tap on Edit>Format.
The Pocket Word toolbar allows you to make quick formatting changes without
having to open a menu.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 241
Chapter 7: Programs
Formatting Text
To apply a formatting style to text in your document:
•
•
Highlight text to which you want to apply a format.
Tap the stylus on an icon in the toolbar to apply that format to the highlighted text.
Cutting, Copying And Pasting
•
•
•
Highlight the text you want to copy by pressing the tip of the stylus just
before the block of text and dragging it to the end of the text you want to
Cut, Copy or Paste.
With the text highlighted, tap and hold the stylus on the text block. In the
pop-up menu, choose Cut or Copy, or
Tap on Edit and then choose Cut or Copy.
Press and hold the stylus at the point in the document where you want to
paste the data. In the pop-up menu, choose Paste, or
Tap on Edit, Paste.
Your text and the formatting attached to it is pasted in the new location.
Adjusting Paragraph Indents
•
•
Tap anywhere in the paragraph to which you want to apply new paragraph alignment.
Tap on Edit, Paragraph.
Figure 7.79 Paragraph Align And Indent Screen
•
In the Alignment drop-down menu, choose the type of alignment you want
to assign to the paragraph–Left, Right and Centre.
242 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Formatting Text
•
•
•
Note:
In the Indentation Left and/or Indentation Right fields, tap the up or down
arrows to changed the indentation in increments of 0.25 centimeters.
To adjust the indentation of only the first line or to create a hanging indent
after the first line, tap the stylus in the drop-down menu next to Special and
choose First Line or Hanging.
In the By field, adjust the spacing in increments of 0.25 centimeters.
To change a paragraph into a bulleted point, tap the stylus in the checkbox next to ‘Bulleted’.
Undoing Or Redoing An Action
•
Tap on Edit, Undo to reverse an action.
If you’ve undone an action and want to redo it:
•
Note:
Tap on Edit, Redo.
You can undo actions multiple times. Keep in mind however that if you
delete a file, you cannot undo the deletion.
Finding Text
•
In a document, tap on Edit, Find/Replace.
Figure 7.80 Find Screen
•
•
Indicate the word for which you are searching, and tap on Find to execute
the search.
To stop searching, tap the X.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 243
Chapter 7: Programs
Formatting Text
Replacing A Word
• In a document, tap on Edit, Find/Replace to display the Find screen,
and tap on the Replace button.
Figure 7.81 Replace Screen
•
•
In the Find What and Replace with fields, type the text you want to find and
the text with which you want to replace it.
Tap on Find.
The first instance of the word is highlighted in your document and the Replace
options are displayed in a toolbar near the bottom of the Word document.
Figure 7.82 Replace Options Screen
•
•
To replace this occurrence, tap on Replace.
When the search and replace is complete, tap on OK.
244 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Sharing Documents With Your PC
7.12.8 Sharing Documents With Your PC
Documents created on a PC are recognized by your WORKABOUT PRO.
However, some formatting is lost when ActiveSync converts a Word document to a
Pocket Word document. This loss also occurs when you open a .doc file and change
it on the WORKBOUT PRO.
For example, suppose your .doc file has a table. Pocket Word cannot display
tables–these are displayed as tabbed text. If you close the file without making any
changes, the table will be preserved when you copy it back to your PC. However, if
you make the slightest change to the table, you’ll be prompted to save the file either
in Desktop Word or Pocket Word format. Even if you choose Desktop, when you
open the document on your PC, the table formatting will be lost.
Important:
To avoid translation problems, you can work on copies of .doc
files. In addition, keep in mind that you can use the Terminal Services Client program to log onto a desktop PC that is also running
Terminal Services, and then you can use any program on your
PC, including Microsoft Word (rather than Pocket Word). Refer
to “Terminal Services Client” on page 245 for details.
7.13 Tasks
This program helps you stay ahead of your schedule by managing your tasks,
appointments, and so on. For details about Tasks, refer to “Task Notification” on
page 50.
7.14 Terminal Services Client
This program allows you to log onto a PC that is running Terminal Services Client
or Remote Desktop so that you can use all the programs available on the PC while
working on your WORKABOUT PRO.
7.14.1 Connecting To A Terminal Server
• Start a remote connect to the server using a modem or network card.
Important: Refer to “Modem Connection Setup” on page 159 and
“Setting Up A Network Card” on page 164 for details about
these connections.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 245
Chapter 7: Programs
Moving Around Terminal Services Client
•
Tap on Start, Programs, Terminal Services Client.
Figure 7.83 Terminal Services Client Screen
1. If the Recent Servers list contains any servers to which you have recently
connected, tap on the server.
2. To connect to a new server, type the server’s name in the Server field.
3. If you are using applications that have been sized for use with the WORKABOUT PRO, tap the stylus in the checkbox next to Limit size of server
desktop to fit on this screen.
4. Tap on the Connect button.
7.14.2 Moving Around Terminal Services Client
You may notice that the desktop PC’s screen is too large to fit in the WORKABOUT
PRO screen. If the scroll bars are displayed, you’ll see more than one set of scroll
bars on your hand-held. To avoid any confusion, it’s best to use the five directional
buttons at the bottom of the Terminal Services Client screen.
To better accommodate screen size, consider enabling in the checkbox next to
‘Limit size of server desktop to fit on this screen’. Refer to Figure 7.83 on page 246.
7.14.3 Improving Display Performance
To speed up display performance by reducing the time it takes to refresh a screen,
you can make a quick adjustment on your PC.
1. On your PC, choose Start, Settings, Control Panel.
2. Tap on the Display icon.
3. Disable the checkbox next to Transition effects for menus and tooltips.
246 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Improving Browser Performance
7.14.4 Improving Browser Performance
When you reduce the time taken to refresh a Web page, Internet Explorer
performance is improved.
1. On your PC, in Internet Explorer, choose Tools, Internet Options, and tap
on the Advanced tab.
2. Disable the check mark next to Use smooth scrolling.
7.14.5 Disconnecting Without Ending A Session
Important:
These commands are accessed from the Start menu in the Terminal Services screen used to access the PC’s commands. Do not use
the Start menu on your WORKABOUT PRO.
1. In the Terminal Services screen, tap on Start, Shutdown.
2. Tap on Disconnect.
7.14.6 Ending A Session
1. In the Terminal Services Client screen, tap on Start, Shutdown.
2. Tap on Log Off.
7.15 Windows Media
Windows Media plays audio files on your WORKABOUT PRO that are in
Windows Media format (.wma or .asf) or MP3 format (.mp3). This program also
plays video files, but only if they are in Windows Media format (.wmv).
Before you launch this program, you may need take a few steps to convert your files
on your PC.
7.15.1 Converting A Media File On Your PC
While you can play other video and audio files in other formats (e.g., .wav, .avi, .mpeg),
you need to convert them before you can play them on your WORKABOUT PRO.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 247
Chapter 7: Programs
Converting A Media File On Your PC
1. On your PC, launch Windows Movie Maker (Start, All Programs, Accessories, Entertainment). If you don’t have this program, go to:
www.microsoft.com/windowsxp/moviemaker.
Tap here to
import video
Tap here to
import audio
Figure 7.84 Windows Movie Maker
2. In the Movie Tasks area under Capture Video, tap on one of the following:
Import Video to import a video file or Import audio or music to import an
audio file.
The Import File dialog box is displayed.
248 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Converting A Media File On Your PC
Figure 7.85 Movie Maker Import File Screen
3. Navigate to the location in which the media file resides.
4. Double-tap on the file you want to convert.
Figure 7.86 Collections Window
A video file, like this example, displays one or more frames of the movie.
An audio file is represented by an icon with a musical note in it.
5. Drag the file’s icon or frame(s) to the timeline at the bottom of the screen:
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 249
Chapter 7: Programs
Converting A Media File On Your PC
Drag video files (use the shift key to select all the frames) to the Video timeline.
Drag the audio file icon to the Audio/Music timeline.
Figure 7.87 Movie Maker Timeline
An audio file is represented in the timeline by a wavy line. A video file can be split
into clips or remain as a single frame.
6. In the Movie Tasks section, tap on the Finish Movie drop-down menu, and
choose Save to my computer to start the Save Movie Wizard.
Figure 7.88 Save Movie Wizard
7. In field number 1, assign a file name.
8. In field number 2, choose the location in which this file will be saved.
250 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Copying Music Files From A CD
9. Tap on Next
Figure 7.89 Movie Settings Screen
10. While the default playback quality settings are recommended, you can make
changes in this screen by tapping on Show more choices.
11. Tap on Next. The Saving Movie dialog box indicates the progress of the file
conversion.
12. Tap on Finish.
Audio files are saved with a .wma extension, and video files are saved with a .wmv
extension.
Note:
If you saved your file somewhere other than your hand-held My Documents folder, you have to place it in that folder to transfer it to your
WORKABOUT PRO during ActiveSync.
7.15.2 Copying Music Files From A CD
You need version 9 or later of Windows Media Player to make use of all the latest
features. If you find that your PC either doesn’t have Windows Media player or has
an earlier version, go to: www.windowsmedia.com/9series/DownLoad/download.asp
1. Connect your PC to the Internet.
2. On your PC, launch Windows Media Player (Start, My Programs, Accessories, Entertainment).
3. Insert an audio CD into your PC’s CD-ROM drive.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 251
Chapter 7: Programs
Copying Music Files From A CD
4. Tap on the Rip tab at the top of the Windows Media screen.
Figure 7.90 Windows Media Rip Screen
The Rip (copy) tab lists all the track titles on the CD you inserted in your PC.
Note:
If you don’t see your CD tracks listed, tap on the ‘Find Album Info’ button
in the upper-right corner of this screen.
By default, all songs are selected (marked with a checkmark) to be ripped if you
have not previously ripped them.
5. Clear the checkboxes next to the titles you do not want to rip (copy). You
can tap in the check box in the upper-left corner, just above the track checkboxes to clear all of them, and then choose the ones you want to rip.
6. The first time you rip music, a dialog box is displayed where you can choose
the format for the files you are creating. Tap on one of the following options:
Keep my current format settings–By default, the Player uses the Windows
Media Audio format, which optimizes the balance between file size and
sound quality. If you choose this option, the songs you selected are ripped to
your PC immediately. You won’t need to tap on the ‘Rip Music’ button.
252 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Copying Music And Video Files To Your Hand-Held
Change my current format settings–Choose this option if you want to
change format, bit rate, storage folder, or other options.
Note:
To tailor the format or audio quality settings at another time, in the Tools
menu, choose Options, and then tap on the Rip Music tab.
Once you’ve made your selection, tap on OK.
7. Tap on the ‘Rip Music’ button
to rip (copy) your selections to
your PC.
Once the songs have been ripped, they are stored under the ‘Library’ tab where you
can play them. The files you want to move to your WORKABOUT PRO are stored in
the ‘My Music’ folder, a sub-folder on your PC.
7.15.3 Copying Music And Video Files To Your Hand-Held
1. Connect your WORKABOUT PRO to your PC.
2. On your PC, go to My Documents or a sub-folder (My Music or My Videos), depending on the type of file you want to move to your hand-held–or
go to the folder in which your media files are stored. Select the media files
and choose Copy.
3. Paste the media files to your WORKABOUT PRO My Documents folder
(or, a subfolder like My Music or My Videos). ActiveSync synchronizes the
files onto your WORKBOUT PRO.
7.15.4 Auto Syncing Music
1. Connect your WORKABOUT PRO to your PC.
2. Open Windows Media Play–All Programs, Accessories, Entertainment.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 253
Chapter 7: Programs
Auto Syncing Music
3. Tap on the Sync tab in the Windows Media screen on your PC.
Figure 7.91 Windows Media Sync Tab
4. Tap on Sync settings.
Figure 7.92 Synchronize Settings
254 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Playing Music And Videos
5. In the Synchronization Settings screen, clear all play list checkboxes, and
then tap on the files you want to synchronize–‘All Music’.
Important:
Make certain that ‘Synchronize device automatically’ is selected.
6. Tap on OK.
Windows Media player checks the media files on the WORKABOUT PRO against
the files in the Windows Media Library. Any files that are not music or picture files
are deleted from the WORKABOUT PRO. Any music or pictures files that are in
the Library but not on the hand-held are added.
Whenever you connect your WORKABOUT PRO to your PC, the music files will
be synchronized.
7.15.5 Playing Music And Videos
Playing music and video on your WORKABOUT PRO works much the same as it
does on your PC. Windows Media converts your hand-held into a portable MP3 and
video player. Keep in mind however that storage is much more limited on your
hand-held than it is on your PC.
To play a music or video file:
1. On your WORKABOUT PRO, tap Start, Programs, Windows Media.
Figure 7.93 Windows Media Player Screen
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 255
Chapter 7: Programs
Playing Music And Videos
2. Tap on Menu, Library.
Figure 7.94 Windows Media Library Screen
3. To update the library to include the media file(s) you copied to your WORKABOUT PRO from your PC, tap on Menu, Update Library.
Figure 7.95 Windows Media Library Update Screen
256 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 7: Programs
Playing Music And Videos
4. Tap on Search to update the media library. Tap on Done once the update has
been completed.
Figure 7.96 Library Update Completion
5. In the updated Library screen, tap on the item in which your media file is
stored–My Music, My Video, and so on. Tap on Play.
Figure 7.97 Windows Media Library Screen
The media file you choose plays in the Windows Media Player screen. If you’re
playing music, the CD cover is displayed in the screen.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 257
Chapter 7: Programs
Windows Media Player Controls
7.15.6 Windows Media Player Controls
The diagram below describes the function of each of the control buttons on the
Windows Media Player screen.
Opens Internet Explorer &
displays the Windowsmedia.com
Web site
Skip to next file
Play
Skip to start of current
file or to previous file
Displays video
at full screen
Turns volume on & off
Increase volume
Decrease volume
Figure 7.98 Media Player Control Buttons
258 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
EXPANSION MODULES
8
8.1 Expansion Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
8.1.1 Removing The End-Cap And Back Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
8.1.2 What’s Inside. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
8.1.3 Shutting Off Power. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
8.1.4 Installing The PC Card Expansion Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
8.1.5 Installing A GSM/GPRS Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
8.1.6 Installing An SE 1223HP Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
8.1.6.1 Enabling The SE 1223HP Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
8.1.7 Installing An SE 923HP Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
8.1.7.1 Enabling The SE 923HP Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
259
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Expansion Modules
8.1 Expansion Modules
Easily installed expansion modules available for the WORKABOUT PRO allow
you to customise this hand-held to meet your specific mobile computing
requirements. This chapter outlines how to install the following expansion modules:
PCMCIA, GSM/GPRS, SE 1223HP and SE 923HP scanner.
8.1.1 Removing The End-Cap And Back Plate
Warning:
The installation of this PC Card Expansion Module must be performed using the appropriate anti-static devices. If unavailable,
discharge static from your body by touching a grounded metallic
object before opening any covers on the unit.
To install a module, you’ll need to remove the end-cap and back plate on the
WORKABOUT PRO. This is a simple process of unfastening four screws on the
end-cap and six screws on the back plate.
Back plate
End-cap
Battery Cover
SW1401
Power Switch
Figure 8.1 Disassembling The WORKABOUT PRO
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 261
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
What’s Inside
8.1.2 What’s Inside
Expansion Connector
Internal Battery
Compact Flash (CF) Connector
SW1401 Power Switch
Main Logic Board
Metal Frame
Figure 8.2 Standard Features
262 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Shutting Off Power
8.1.3 Shutting Off Power
Before installing a module or card in the WORKABOUT PRO, all power sources
must be turned off.
•
•
•
Remove the battery. If your unit is using AC power, disconnect it.
Remove the stylus from end-cap.
Remove the end-cap, and slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off
internal battery power.
SW1401 Power Switch
Figure 8.3 SW1401 Power Switch
8.1.4 Installing The PC Card Expansion Module
The PC Card Expansion Module (model WA9001) is designed to work with various
PC Cards that extend beyond the PC Card frame, such as radio cards with antennas.
The kit consists of a PCMCIA Card, screws, and a mechanical stop that will fit Psion
Teklogix CF cards for the WORKABOUT PRO and most other PC Card types.
Important:
The WORKABOUT PRO does not support hot swapping. All
power sources must be turned off before inserting any card or
module in the unit.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 263
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Installing The PC Card Expansion Module
To insert a PCMCIA PC card in your WORKABOUT, you will need to install a
PCMCIA module equipped with a 100-pin connector. This module snaps onto the
expansion connector on your WORKABOUT PRO.
Important:
Backup any data in RAM first, since it will be erased when the
unit is turned off.
Mechanical Stopper
PCMCIA Expansion Module
Figure 8.4 PCMCIA Module And Mechanical Stopper
•
•
•
Remove the battery. If your unit is using AC power, disconnect it.
Remove the end-cap and back plate.
Slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off internal battery power.
•
•
Remove the two screws at the top of the metal frame.
Align the PCMCIA Card connector with the expansion connector on the
WORKABOUT PRO. Apply slight pressure to snap the module into place
on the hand-held.
Use four of the screws provided to secure the PCMCIA Card into place
(additional screws have been provided for convenience). Tighten the screws
to a torque of 2 lbs-in (2 kgf-cm), or until finger tight.
•
Important:
Once the PCMCIA module is installed in the unit, you do not
need to remove the back plate to insert a PCMCIA PC card. Just
remove the end-cap and slide the card into the unit.
264 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Installing A GSM/GPRS Module
•
Apply gentle downward pressure to securely seat the card in the connector.
Insert the PCMCIA card as
shown here, with the label
facing you.
Figure 8.5 Inserting A PCMCIA Card
•
•
•
Align the mechanical stop and use the four screws provided to secure in place.
Tighten the screws to a torque of 2 lbs-in (2 kgf-cm), or until finger-tight.
Slide the SW1401 switch to the right to turn power back on.
Replace the end-cap. Tighten the end-cap screws to a torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgfcm), and replace the back plate and battery.
8.1.5 Installing A GSM/GPRS Module
Warning:
The installation of this GSM/GPRS module must be performed
using the appropriate anti-static devices. If unavailable, discharge
static from your body by touching a grounded metallic object
before opening any covers on the unit.
The GSM/GPRS module (model # RA3010) accommodates a GSM radio, a SIM
card (sold separately) and is equipped with a built-in antenna, which also acts as a
mechanical stop for the CF card. The module snaps onto the expansion connector on
your WORKABOUT PRO.
Important:
•
Backup any data in RAM first, since it will be erased when the
unit is turned off.
Remove the battery. If your unit is using AC power, disconnect it.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 265
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Installing A GSM/GPRS Module
•
•
Remove the stylus from the end-cap, and then remove the end-cap at the top
of the WORKABOUT PRO.
Slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off internal battery power.
Important:
In order for the WORKABOUT PRO to access the GSM network,
ensure that you slide the SIM (Subscriber Identity Module) card
into the GSM/GPRS module before installing that unit in the
WORKABOUT PRO.
With the power shut down, you can install the GSM/GPRS module and the antenna.
• Slide the SIM card into the GSM/GPRS module as shown in Figure 8.6,
with the card oriented printed side up and its notch on the right side.
• Align the GSM/GPRS connector with the expansion connector on the
WORKABOUT PRO. Apply slight pressure to snap the module into place
on the hand-held.
• Settle the SIM Card stopper plate into place with its metal tab inserted into
the SIM Card stopper plate slot on the GSM/GPRS module (for tab and slot
locations see Figure 8.6). Ensure that the scanner flex cable lies on top of
the plate.
• Use the four screws provided to secure the module and SIM Card stopper
plate in place. Tighten the screws to a torque of 2 lbs-in (2 kgf-cm) or until
finger tight
SIM Card
Bracket
GSM/GPRS
Radio
SIM Card
Stopper Plate
Slot
GSM/GPRS Module with SIM Card installed
SIM Card Stopper Plate
SIM Card
Tab
Figure 8.6 Inserting The SIM Into The GSM/GPRS Module
266 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Installing A GSM/GPRS Module
•
Fit the antenna at the top of the unit making certain that the antenna contacts
are aligned with the contacts on the GSM/GPRS module (see Figure 8.7).
Ensure that the tab at the top of the antenna is inserted under the lip of the
WORKABOUT PRO’s black plastic frame (Figure 8.8).
Use the screws provided to secure the antenna on the metal frame. Tighten
the screws to a torque of 2 lbs-in (2 kgf-cm, or until finger tight.
•
Tab
Antenna
Antenna Contacts
GSM/GPRS Module
Figure 8.7 Installing The Antenna
GSM/GPRS Module with
SIM Card Stopper Plate
in place
Antenna
Scanner Flex Cable
Location of Antenna Tab
tucked beneath unit frame
Figure 8.8 An Installed GSM/GPRS
•
•
•
Slide the SW1401 switch to the right to turn power back on.
Replace the end-cap. Tighten the end-cap screws to a torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgfcm), and replace the back plate and battery.
Verify the installation by turning on the unit and checking that the signal
strength icon is available in the taskbar, or that “Expansion Slot - Psion Teklogix GPRS” is listed under Properties, in the Control Panel System Properties menu.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 267
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Installing An SE 1223HP Scanner
8.1.6 Installing An SE 1223HP Scanner
Warning:
Anti-static devices MUST BE USED during the installation of
this scanner module. If unavailable, discharge static from your
body by touching a grounded metallic object before opening any
covers on the unit.
The SE 1223HP scanner (model # WA9000) is the internal scanner module
available with the WORKABOUT PRO. To install it:
•
•
•
•
Remove the battery. If your unit is using AC power, disconnect it.
Remove the stylus and then, remove the end-cap at the top of the
WORKABOUT PRO.
Slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off internal battery power.
Remove the back plate from the unit.
A scanner flex cable is already attached to the WORKABOUT PRO. You need to
connect the flex cable to the internal scanner module.
•
•
Scanner
Module
Remove the adhesive tape which holds the flex cable in a folded position.
Insert the flex cable into the connector on the scanner module. If necessary,
use pincers to hold the flex cable.
Connector
Flex
Cable
Figure 8.9 Attaching The Flex Cable To The Scanner Module
268 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Enabling The SE 1223HP Scanner
•
•
•
Fit the scanner module over the back of the WORKABOUT PRO–it
replaces the back plate of the unit.
Fasten the module in place with the screws provided. Tighten the screws to
a torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgf-cm).
Slide the SW1401 power switch to the right to turn power back on, and
replace the end-cap, backplate and battery. Tighten the end-cap screws to a
torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgf-cm).
Figure 8.10 Scanner Module Installed In WORKABOUT PRO
8.1.6.1
•
•
•
•
Enabling The SE 1223HP Scanner
Simultaneously, press and hold down the <BLUE> <ENTER> and left
<SCAN> keys for a minimum of 6 seconds. A Command> prompt is
displayed on the WORKABOUT PRO screen.
Type s to display the Scanner> prompt. A list of supported scanners is
displayed.
Type 2 and press <ENTER> to activate scanner type SE 1223HP.
At the Command> prompt, type 1 (one) to reboot the unit to
Windows Mobile 2003 SE.
8.1.7 Installing An SE 923HP Scanner
Warning:
Anti-static devices MUST BE USED during the installation of
this scanner module. If unavailable, discharge static from your
body by touching a grounded metallic object before opening any
covers on the unit.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 269
Chapter 8: Expansion Modules
Enabling The SE 923HP Scanner
The SE 923HP scanner (model # WA9002) is the internal scanner module available
with the WORKABOUT PRO. To install it:
•
•
•
•
Remove the battery. If your unit is using AC power, disconnect it.
Remove the stylus and then, remove the end-cap at the top of the
WORKABOUT PRO.
Slide the SW1401 switch to the left to shut off internal battery power.
Remove the back plate from the unit.
A scanner flex cable is already attached to the WORKABOUT PRO. You need to
connect the flex cable to the internal scanner module.
•
•
•
•
•
8.1.7.1
•
•
•
•
Remove the adhesive tape that holds the flex cable in a folded position.
Insert the flex cable into the connector on the scanner module (refer to
Figure 8.9 on page 268). If necessary, use pincers to hold the flex cable.
Fit the scanner module over the back of the WORKABOUT PRO—it
replaces the back plate of the unit.
Fasten the module in place with the screws provided. Tighten the screws to
a torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgf-cm), or until finger tight.
Slide the SW1401 power switch to the right to turn power back on, and
replace the end-cap and battery. Tighten the end-cap screws to a torque of 3
lbs-in (3kgf-cm), or until finger tight
Enabling The SE 923HP Scanner
Simultaneously, press and hold down the <BLUE> <ENTER> and left
<SCAN> keys for a minimum of 6 seconds. A Command> prompt is displayed on the WORKABOUT PRO screen.
Type s to display the Scanner> prompt. A list of supported scanners is displayed.
Type 3 and press <ENTER> to activate scanner type SE 923HP.
At the Command> prompt, type 1 (one) to reboot the unit to Windows Mobile
2003 SE.
270 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
PERIPHERAL DEVICES & ACCESSORIES
9
9.1 Carrying Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
9.1.1 Attaching The Hand Strap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
9.1.2 Attaching The Pistol Grip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
9.1.3 Protective Carrying Case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
9.1.3.1 Using The Swivel Belt Loop With The Carrying Case . . . . . 277
9.1.4 Soft Shell Holster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
9.2 The Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
9.2.1 Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
9.3 Chargers And Docking Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
9.3.1 Installation–Chargers And Docking Stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
9.3.2 Power Consumption Considerations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
9.3.3 Operator Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
9.3.4 Important Charger Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
9.4 Desktop Docking Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
9.4.1 Charging A Battery Installed In The WORKABOUT PRO. . . . . . 285
9.4.2 Charging A Spare Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
9.4.3 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
9.4.4 Charger LED Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
9.4.5 Troubleshooting The Charging Operation Of The Dock . . . . . . . 286
9.4.6 Desktop Docking Station Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
9.4.7 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To A PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
9.4.7.1 Using Microsoft® ActiveSync® To Work With Files . . . . . 287
9.4.8 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To An Ethernet Network . . . . . . 288
9.4.8.1 Network Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
9.4.9 Troubleshooting The Docking Station Operations. . . . . . . . . . . 288
9.5 Single Battery Charger–Model #WA3001 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
9.5.1 Inserting A Battery In The Single Battery Charger . . . . . . . . . . 289
9.5.2 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
271
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
9.5.3 Charge Indicators–The LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
9.6 Quad Battery Charger–Model #WA3004 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
9.6.1 Charging Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
9.6.2 Battery Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.3 Charge Indicators–The LEDs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.4 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.4.1 Excessive Charge Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.4.2 Indicator Flashing Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.4.3 Power LED Does Not Light Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
9.6.4.4 Indicator Does Not Light When Battery Installed . . . . . . . 292
9.7 Quad Docking Station–Model #WA4004. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
9.7.1 Quad Docking Station Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
9.7.2 Quad Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
9.7.3 Inserting A WORKABOUT In The Quad Docking Station . . . . . . 293
9.7.4 Network Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
9.7.4.1 Network Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
9.7.5 Battery Charging–LED Behaviour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
9.7.6 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
9.7.6.1 Network Link Unsuccessful . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
9.7.6.2 Hand-Held LED Does Not Light When Docked . . . . . . . 294
9.8 AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
9.9 Cigarette Lighter Adaptor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
9.10 The Vehicle Cradle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
9.10.1 Vehicle Cradle Mounting Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
9.10.1.1 Mounting Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
9.10.2 Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
9.10.3 Using The Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
9.10.4 Maintaining The Vehicle Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
9.10.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles . . . . . . . . 300
9.10.6 Powered Vehicle Cradle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
9.10.6.1 Wiring Vehicle Power To The Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
9.10.7 The Port Replicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
9.11 Bluetooth Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
272 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Carrying Accessories
9.1 Carrying Accessories
There are a variety of carrying accessories to help the operator work safely and
comfortably with the WORKABOUT PRO.
Carrying Accessory
Model Number
Hand Strap
WA6020
Pistol Grip
WA6001
Protective Vinyl Case
WA6090
Soft Shell Holster
WA6050
Table 9.1 Carrying Accessories
Important:
Do not use adhesives such as Loctite to secure the screws on
carrying accessories. These chemicals may damage the plastic
casing.
9.1.1 Attaching The Hand Strap
The hand strap can be attached to the back of the WORKABOUT PRO to provide a
secure means for operators to carry the hand-held.
The hand strap is attached to the back of unit using two Phillips head screws
provided with this accessory.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 273
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Attaching The Hand Strap
•
Use a Phillips screwdriver to attach the strap to the two threaded inserts on
the back of the WORKABOUT PRO, near the top of the unit
Figure 9.1 Securing The Hand Strap
•
Stretch the hand strap toward the base of the WORKABOUT PRO, and
hook the bottom of the strap into the slot near the base of the battery pack.
Figure 9.2 Attaching The Hand Strap
274 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Attaching The Pistol Grip
9.1.2 Attaching The Pistol Grip
The pistol grip is attached to the four threaded inserts on the back of the WORKABOUT PRO. Four Phillips head screws are provided with this accessory.
Figure 9.3 Pistol Grip
Note:
Prior to installation, make sure the trigger mechanism is securely
snapped into the pistol grip body and that the trigger operates properly.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 275
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Protective Carrying Case
•
•
Position the pistol grip so that it fits snugly over the back of the unit and the
holes in the pistol grip are aligned with the threaded inserts on the back of
the WORKABOUT PRO.
Tighten the screws to a torque of 3 lbs-in (3kgf-cm) to secure the pistol grip
in place.
9.1.3 Protective Carrying Case
A carrying case is available for WORKABOUT PROs to shield the unit from
damage. It is equipped with a soft plastic window to protect the unit display
and keyboard.
Figure 9.4 Carrying Case
276 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Using The Swivel Belt Loop With The Carrying Case
9.1.3.1
Using The Swivel Belt Loop With The Carrying Case
The WORKABOUT PRO carrying case is equipped with two rings onto which you
can attach a swivel belt loop so that you can hang the unit from your belt. If you
prefer, you can also attach a belt clip to this accessory so that you can clamp the unit
onto your waistband or belt. (rather than slide your belt through the belt loop).
Figure 9.5 Belt Loop And Belt Clip
•
•
Clip the two hooks on the belt strap to the bottom of the carrying case.
Slide your belt through the belt loop.
Figure 9.6 Attaching The Belt Loop
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 277
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Using The Swivel Belt Loop With The Carrying Case
Alternatively, you can attach a plastic clip to the swivel belt loop and clip it to your
waistband or belt.
Belt Clip
Figure 9.7 Belt Clip
278 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Soft Shell Holster
9.1.4 Soft Shell Holster
A soft shell holster with removable belt and swivel holster pad can be used to hang a
WORKABOUT PRO with a pistol grip from you waist
Soft Shell Holster
Swivel Holster Pad and
Removable Belt
Figure 9.8 Soft Shell Holster
•
•
•
Insert the belt in the swivel holster pad.
Attach the pad on either the left or right side of the holster case, depending
on whether you are left- or right-handed.
Fasten the belt comfortably around your waist. Slide the adjustable ring on
the belt to tighten the holster in place.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 279
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
The Batteries
9.2 The Batteries
Note:
Review “Specifications” on page 305 for detailed information.
The WORKABOUT PRO will operate with a Standard Lithium Ion battery pack, a
High-Capacity Lithium Ion battery pack or three AA alkaline batteries. If you are
using a Lithium Ion battery pack, it must first be charged.
In addition to the main battery, the hand-held is equipped with a rechargable coin
battery–a Maxell ML2032.
9.2.1 Lithium Ion Battery Safety Precautions
Important:
It is critical that this safety information be reviewed and that all
warnings be strictly followed.
Warning:
BATTERIES ARE CONSIDERED HAZARDOUS WASTE and
must be returned to Psion Teklogix for proper disposal. All used
batteries must be forwarded to one of the following offices:
Psion Teklogix Inc.
Psion Teklogix Corp.
2100 Meadowvale Blvd.
1810 Airport Exchange Blvd.
Mississauga, Ontario
Suite 500
Canada
Erlanger, Kentucky
L5N 7J9
USA 41018
Psion Teklogix S.A.
La Duranne; 135 Rue Rene Descartes; BP 421000
13591 Aix-En-Provence
Cedex 3; France
Warning:
TO PREVENT the battery from leaking acid, generating heat or
exploding, adhere to precautions listed below.
•
•
•
•
•
There is a risk of explosion if a WORKABOUT PRO battery is replaced
with an incorrect type.
The battery incorporates built-in safety devices. To ensure
their proper function, do not disassemble or alter any parts
of the battery.
Do not short-circuit the battery by directly connecting any of the exposed
terminals with metal objects such as wire. Do not transport or store the
battery together with metal objects such as necklaces, hair pins, etc.
Do not dispose of batteries in fire.
Do not use or leave the battery near a heat source such as a fire
or heater.
280 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Chargers And Docking Stations
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Do not immerse the battery in water.
When charging, use the battery charger specifically designed for
the battery.
Do not pierce, strike, throw or step on the battery.
Do not directly solder the battery.
Do not connect the battery to an electrical outlet, vehicle
cigarette lighter, etc.
Do not put battery into a microwave oven or pressurized container.
Do not use the battery in combination with primary batteries (such as
dry-cell batteries) or batteries of different capacities or brands.
Immediately remove the battery from the device or battery charger
and stop use if the battery gives off an odor, generates heat, becomes
discoloured or deformed, or in any way appears abnormal during use.
Do not continue charging the battery if it does not recharge within the
specified charge time.
The battery may burst or ignite if the battery leaks. Always ensure that it
is away from any exposed flames.
If leaking electrolyte sprays into your eyes, rinse them with clean
running water, and immediately seek medical attention.
Do not store the battery in extremely high temperatures (e.g., a vehicle,
strong direct sunlight, etc.). This may cause the battery to overheat
or ignite, and it may also reduce the performance and service life of
the battery.
Do not use in areas where static electricity is greater than what the
manufacturer guarantees.
Keep batteries out of reach of children.
9.3 Chargers And Docking Stations
Important:
Keep in mind when ordering a charger or docking station, you
must also order the appropriate power cord separately.
Psion Teklogix offers a variety of chargers and docking stations for the
WORKABOUT PRO. These include:
• Single Battery Charger–Model #WA3001
• Quad Battery Charger–Model #WA3004
• Desktop Docking Station–Model #WA4002-1 and for the WORKABOUT
PRO S – Model #WA4102-1
• Quad Docking Station–Model #WA4004
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 281
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Installation–Chargers And Docking Stations
9.3.1 Installation–Chargers And Docking Stations
When installing a charger or docking station at your site, consider the following
guidelines.
• Keep chargers and docking stations away from excessive dirt, dust and
contaminants.
• Chargers will not charge batteries outside an ambient temperature range
of 0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F). It is recommended that the charger or
docking station be operated at room temperature–between 18° C and 25° C
(64° F to 77° F) for maximum performance.
After unpacking your unit:
• Visually inspect the charger for possible damage.
• Install the IEC power cord and apply power.
9.3.2 Power Consumption Considerations
Check to ensure the mains circuit supplying chargers and/or docking stations is
adequate for the load, especially if several chargers and docking stations are being
powered from the same circuit.
• Quad charger–can consume up to 2A @ 120VAC or 1A @ 240VAC.
• Quad docking station–can consume up to 3A @ 120VAC or 1.5A @
240VAC.
9.3.3 Operator Controls
WORKABOUT PRO docking stations and chargers have no operator controls or
power switches.
9.3.4 Important Charger Safety Instructions
•
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS–This manual contains important safety and
operating instructions for battery charger s.
•
Before using the battery charger, read all instructions and cautionary
markings on (1) battery charger, (2) battery, and (3) product using battery.
•
The mains power cord shall comply with national safety regulations of the country
where the equipment is to be sold.
•
Use of an attachment not recommended or sold by the battery charger
manufacturer may result in fire, electric shock, or personal injury.
282 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Important Charger Safety Instructions
•
To reduce risk of damage to the electric plug and cord when unplugging the
charger, pull the plug rather than the cord.
•
Make sure the cord is positioned so that it is not stepped on, tripped over,
or otherwise subjected to damage or stress.
•
Do not operate the charger with a damaged cord or plug.
Replace immediately.
•
Do not operate the charger if it has received a sharp blow, been dropped, or otherwise damaged in any way; it should be inspected by qualified service personnel.
•
Do not disassemble the charger; it should be repaired by qualified service personnel. Incorrect reassembly may result in electric shock or fire.
•
To reduce risk of electric shock, unplug the charger from the outlet before
attempting any maintenance or cleaning.
•
An extension cord should not be used unless absolutely necessary. Use of an
improper extension cord could result in fire or electric shock.
If an extension cord must be used, make sure:
•
•
The plug pins on the extension cord are the same number, size,
and shape as those on the charger.
• The extension cord is properly wired and in good electrical
condition and that the wire size is larger than 16 AWG.
Do not expose the charger to rain or snow.
•
Do not place batteries in the charger if they are cold from extended
exposure to a freezer or outside temperatures below 10°C (50°F). Allow them to
warm up to room temperature for at least two hours.
•
Do not use the charger if, after an overnight charge, any of the batteries feel warmer
than the charger housing. The charger should be inspected by
qualified service personnel.
•
Do not use the charger if any of the batteries or the charger get more than lukewarm. The equipment should be inspected by qualified personnel.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 283
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Desktop Docking Station
9.4 Desktop Docking Station
There are two desktop docking stations available–your choice depends on
which type of WORKABOUT PRO you are using. Desktop docking station
model WA4002-1 is designed for use with the WORKABOUT PRO C. Model
WA4102-1 is designed for use with the WORKABOUT PRO S.
WORKABOUT PRO
Charge Well
Docking Station
Connector Pins
LED Legend
Figure 9.9 Desktop Docking Station
Note:
The desktop docking charger is shipped with its own user manual. It is
critical that it be reviewed for additional information and updates.
The desktop docking station is designed to charge the battery installed in the
WORKABOUT PRO along with a spare battery pack.
Spare Battery
Charge Well
DC IN Socket
Figure 9.10 Back Of Desktop Docking Station
284 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Charging A Battery Installed In The WORKABOUT PRO
Important:
This docking station can only be used to charge Psion Teklogix
approved Lithium-Ion batteries–specifically model numbers
WA3000 and WA3002.
9.4.1 Charging A Battery Installed In The WORKABOUT PRO
•
•
Insert the DC power cable to the DC IN socket on the desktop docking
station. Plug the pronged end of the cable into an AC outlet.
Slide the hand-held into the docking station, making certain that the LIF
(Low Insertion Force) port on base of the WORKABOUT is securely
seated on the docking station connector pins. An icon is displayed in the
taskbar of the hand-held indicating that the unit is properly installed in the
This icon is only displayed when the unit is switched on.
station–
The LED on the WORKABOUT PRO lights up indicating that the unit has external
power and battery charging will begin. It is safe to leave the unit in the desktop
docking station while it is not in use–the battery will not be overcharged.
9.4.2 Charging A Spare Battery
•
Insert the battery in the spare battery charge well at the back of the docking
station, aligning the contacts on the battery with the contacts in the spare
battery charge well.
9.4.3 Battery Charge Duration
A fully discharged battery can take up to 5 hours to charge. The desktop docking
station stops applying power to the battery when it is fully charged–there is no risk
of overcharge if the battery remains in the charge well.
9.4.4 Charger LED Indicators
Figure 9.11 Battery Charge Status
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 285
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Troubleshooting The Charging Operation Of The Dock
The desktop docking station is equipped with a single dual-coloured LED indicator
in the lower-right corner of the front panel.
LED Behaviour
Icon
Charge Status
Off
No battery detected in the slot.
Solid Green
Charge in progress.
Fast Flashing Green
Battery charged to less than 80% of capacity.
Slow Flashing Green
Battery charged to greater than 80% of capacity.
Solid Red
Battery temperature outside of charge range–
0° C to 50 °C.
Flashing Red
Battery is not charging. Battery fault.
Table 9.2 Desktop Battery Charger LED Behaviour
Note:
Battery charging continues whether the hand-held is switched on or off.
9.4.5 Troubleshooting The Charging Operation Of The Dock
The quad battery charger troubleshooting section beginning on page 291 also
applies to the charging behaviour of the desktop docking station.
9.4.6 Desktop Docking Station Ports
Host USB Port
Client USB Port
DC IN Socket
Figure 9.12 Back of Desktop Docking Station
The desktop docking station is equipped with two USB ports–a Host USB port to
connect peripherals such as a printer, keyboard, etc. and a Client USB to connect the
docking station to a PC.
286 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To A PC
9.4.7 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To A PC
The desktop docking station can be connected to a PC so that you can exchange files
in the same way that you would between PC drives. A USB cable is included with
your docking station.
To link the WORKABOUT PRO to a PC:
• Insert the hand-held in the desktop docking station.
• Insert the USB cable into the docking station Client USB connector. Attach
the other end of the cable to a USB port on the PC.
You’ll need to install connectivity software on your PC before you can pass
information between the hand-held and the PC.
9.4.7.1
Using Microsoft® ActiveSync® To Work With Files
ActiveSync®–Microsoft PC connectivity software–can be used to connect the
WORKABOUT PRO to PCs running this software. You’ll be able to:
• View WORKABOUT PRO files from Windows Explorer.
• Drag and drop files between the WORKABOUT PRO and the PC in the
same way that you would between PC drives.
• Back up WORKABOUT PRO files to the PC, then restore them from the
PC to the hand-held again, if needed, and so on.
You can use the Companion CD included with your WORKABOUT PRO to install
ActiveSync.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 287
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To An Ethernet Network
9.4.8 Linking A WORKABOUT PRO To An Ethernet Network
An USB-Ethernet adaptor cable–model number WA4010–is used to connect the
WORKABOUT PRO to an Ethernet network through a desktop docking station
(model number 4002 or 4102).
Ethernet
Port
USB
Connector
Figure 9.13 USB-Ethernet Adaptor Cable
•
•
9.4.8.1
Insert the adaptor’s USB connector into the Host USB port on the desktop
docking station.
Connect your network Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port on the
adaptor cable.
Network Access
The hand-held unit automatically detects insertion into the desktop dock and loads
the appropriate drivers to communicate with the USB-Ethernet converters.
Network Addressing
The host application uses standard TCP/IP protocol to name, locate and
communicate with a specific WORKABOUT PRO on the network.
If a link is established between a WORKABOUT PRO and a host, the application
on the host and on the hand-held must have a recovery mechanism in the event that
the WORKABOUT PRO is removed from the dock, interrupting the link.
9.4.9 Troubleshooting The Docking Station Operations
The indicators, applications and drivers required to use and monitor the desktop
docking station as a dock (as opposed to a charger) are installed on the
WORKABOUT PRO–no applications are present on the docking station itself.
288 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Single Battery Charger–Model #WA3001
9.5 Single Battery Charger–Model #WA3001
Figure 9.14 Single Battery Charger
The single battery charger is designed to charge a single battery. It has a DC IN
socket and is equipped with one LED that indicates the status of the charge process.
9.5.1 Inserting A Battery In The Single Battery Charger
•
•
Insert the DC power plug into the charger. Plug the pronged end of the
power cable into an AC outlet.
Install the battery, aligning the contacts on the battery with the contacts in
the battery charge well.
9.5.2 Battery Charge Duration
It can take up to 4 hours to fully charge a battery. The single battery charger stops
applying power to the battery when it is fully charged–there is no risk of overcharge
if the battery remains in the charge well. The 75% charge indicator is handy if you
need a quick recharge–a quick charge often takes less than one hour.
9.5.3 Charge Indicators–The LED
The LED on the top of the charger indicates battery charge progress.
LED Behaviour
Charge Status
Off
No battery detected in the charge well.
Solid green
Battery is fully charged.
Fast flashing green
Battery is charged to 75% of capacity.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 289
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Quad Battery Charger–Model #WA3004
Slow flashing green
Charge in progress.
Solid red
Battery is outside ambient temperature range of
0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F).
Flashing red
Charge alarm indicating a charging circuit problem.
Refer to “Troubleshooting” on page 291 for details.
Flashing red then green
in a 3 second cycle
Power up test sequence.
Table 9.3 Single Battery LED Behaviour
Note:
Battery charging continues whether the hand-held is switched on or off.
9.6 Quad Battery Charger–Model #WA3004
Table 9.4 Quad Battery Charger
The quad battery charger is designed to charge up to four Lithium Ion batteries at
one time.
Note:
The gang charger is shipped with a user manual. It is critical that this
manual be reviewed for additional information and updates.
9.6.1 Charging Batteries
•
Slide the battery into a charge well, aligning the contacts on the battery with
the contacts in the charge well.
290 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Battery Charge Duration
9.6.2 Battery Charge Duration
A fully discharged battery can take up to 4 hours to charge. The quad battery charger
stops applying power to the battery when it is fully charged–there is no risk of
overcharge if the battery remains in the charge well. The 75% charge indicator is
handy if you need a quick recharge–a quick charge often takes less than one hour.
9.6.3 Charge Indicators–The LEDs
Each battery charge well is equipped with an LED to indicate the charge status of
the battery. When a battery is inserted in the charger, the colour and behaviour of the
LED associated with the charge well in use indicates the status of the charge. Refer
to Table 9.3 on page 290 for details.
9.6.4 Troubleshooting
9.6.4.1
Excessive Charge Duration
The charger is equipped with a recalibration function–a function that fully
discharges and then fully recharges the battery. This process is necessary to
recalibrate the battery capacity gauge internal to the battery. The charger attempts
recalibration when:
• the battery capacity is at less than 30%, and
• the battery has undergone more than 40 partial charge cycles since the last
full discharge.
The recalibration function extends the charge time by up to 2 hours.
9.6.4.2
Indicator Flashing Red
If the indicator flashes red:
• Remove all batteries and disconnect the mains power cable.
• Wait at least 20 seconds, and then plug the cable in again.
If any of the charge well LEDs continue to flash red, the charger is defective and
requires service. If all indicators are flashing red, there is a power supply problem
and the charger requires service.
9.6.4.3
•
•
•
Power LED Does Not Light Up
Remove all batteries, and unplug the charger.
Connect another device to the mains outlet to ensure there is power.
Remove the IEC mains power cable from the charger, and check it for damage.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 291
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Indicator Does Not Light When Battery Installed
•
Reconnect the mains cable in the charger and mains outlet.
If the power LED still does not light up:
• Unplug the mains cable, and check the fuse at the rear of the charger.
If the fuse appears to be intact, the charger requires service.
9.6.4.4
•
•
•
•
•
Indicator Does Not Light When Battery Installed
Remove the battery, and clean the contacts on the battery and the
charge well.
Reinstall the battery, and check that it is fully seated in the charger well.
Inspect the charge well contacts for damage (are they bent, flattened,
twisted or broken).
Try inserting a battery that you know to be working in the charger well.
Reconnect the mains power cable, and check that the charger well indicator
flashes at powerup.
9.7 Quad Docking Station–Model #WA4004
Figure 9.15 Quad Docking Station
Note:
The quad docking station is shipped with a docking manual. It is critical
that this manual be reviewed for additional information and updates.
292 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Quad Docking Station Setup
The quad docking station permits each of four docked WORKABOUT PROs to
communicate with a 10/100 BaseT Ethernet network at greater than 2Mbps. It also
provides sufficient power to operate and fast charge the batteries in the units.
9.7.1 Quad Docking Station Setup
After unpacking the unit:
•
•
Visually inspect the unit for any damage.
Install the IEC power cord and apply power.
A green indicator in the lower-right corner of the front panel lights up to indicate
that power is present.
•
Attach a CAT5 RJ45 network patch cable (supplied) between your network
and the RJ45 jack on the rear of the dock.
A green LED is illuminated next to the RJ45 connector when a valid network link is
established.
A user application must be loaded onto each WORKABOUT PRO that utilizes the
quad dock for communication. When the network is connected and this application
is loaded, the quad dock is ready for use.
9.7.2 Quad Indicators
The quad dock is equipped with a power indicator LED and RJ45 link and traffic
indicator LEDs. When a valid network link is established, a green LED is
illuminated next to the RJ45 connector.
9.7.3 Inserting A WORKABOUT In The Quad Docking Station
•
Slide the WORKABOUT PRO into the cradle portion of the quad dock
until lightly latched.
The hand-held detects that it is in a quad dock and momentarily displays the appropriate
. The LED on the hand-held unit
icon in the navigation bar at the top of the screen–
lights up to show it has external power and may start charging the battery.
Interaction with the WORKABOUT PRO while in the quad dock is a function of
the user application software used to communicate with the host network.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 293
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Network Access
9.7.4 Network Access
The quad docking station has one 10/100 Ethernet port. You can insert up to four
hand-held units. The hand-helds are connected to an internal USB hub. The handheld unit automatically detects insertion into a quad docking station and loads the
appropriate drivers to communicate with the USB/Ethernet converters.
9.7.4.1
Network Addressing
Although the USB converters have fixed Ethernet MAC addresses, there is
generally no correlation between these addresses and a specific hand-held. The host
application uses standard TCP/IP protocol to name, locate and communicate with a
specific WORKABOUT PRO on the network.
If a link is established between a WORKABOUT PRO and a host, the application
on the host and on the hand-held must have a recovery mechanism in the event that
the WORKABOUT PRO is removed from the dock and the link is interrupted.
9.7.5 Battery Charging–LED Behaviour
The quad docking station supplies DC power to enable the WORKABOUT PRO
internal fast charger. Charge status is displayed on the hand-held LED–the LED
turns red while the battery is being charged and turns green once the charge is
complete. If the battery is fully charged when the unit is inserted in the docking
station, the LED flashes red for less than a second and then turns green. Battery
charging continues whether the WORKABOUT PRO is switched on or off.
It can take up to 5 hours to fully charge the internal battery.
9.7.6 Troubleshooting
The indicators, applications and drivers required to use and monitor the docking
station are installed on the WORKABOUT PRO–no indicators or applications are
present on the docking station itself.
9.7.6.1
Network Link Unsuccessful
If a network link fails, the WORKABOUT PRO application alerts the operator that
the link was unsuccessful.
9.7.6.2
•
Hand-Held LED Does Not Light When Docked
Check that the quad docking station has power–is the Power LED on the
docking station illuminated?
294 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable
•
•
•
•
•
•
Try inserting the WORKABOUT PRO in another well in the quad dock.
Check for dirt or contamination on the docking contacts at the bottom of the
WORKABOUT PRO. Wipe the contacts with a damp cloth if necessary.
Check the pogo pins inside the dock cradle for dirt. Gently wipe with a
damp cloth if they appear to be dirty or discoloured.
Check that the pogo pins are not bent or damaged.
Remove and reinsert the WORKABOUT PRO in the cradle, and check that
the latch is holding the unit in place (the pogo pins must be compressed for
proper contact).
Make certain that the battery installed in the WORKABOUT PRO is not
defective.
9.8 AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable
AC Power Lead
(sold separately)
Tether
Connector
Tether
Cable
Universal AC
Power Supply
DC Power Plug
DC IN Socket
Tether Port
Figure 9.16 WORKABOUT PRO AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 295
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
AC Wall Adaptor And Tether Cable
Audio
Jack
Low Insertion
Force Port
(LIF)
Tether
Port
Figure 9.17 Bottom Of WORKABOUT PRO
Connecting a wall adaptor (WA3220) and tether cable (CA1050) to your
WORKABOUT PRO will supply AC power to your unit. The tether cable is
equipped with a tether port so that you can attach a peripheral device to the
hand-held while providing power. A power lead must be ordered separately.
• Insert the tether connector into the tether port on your hand-held. Tighten
the screws to secure the cable in place.
• Insert the DC power plug into the DC IN socket on the tether cable, connect
the AC power lead to the Universal AC Power Supply.
• Plug the pronged end of the lead into an AC outlet.
296 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Cigarette Lighter Adaptor
9.9 Cigarette Lighter Adaptor
Fuse
Cigarette Lighter Adaptor
Tether
Connector
Tether
Cable
DC Power Plug
Tether
Port
DC IN Socket
Figure 9.18 Cigarette Lighter Adaptor
The cigarette lighter adaptor is an optional accessory that allows you to power your
WORKABOUT PRO through your vehicle cigarette lighter.
• Attach a tether cable (see Figure 9.16 on page 295) to the base of the
WORKABOUT PRO.
• Insert the cigarette lighter adaptor DC power plug into the DC IN socket on
the tether cable.
• Insert the adaptor in your vehicle cigarette lighter outlet to power your unit.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 297
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
The Vehicle Cradle
9.10 The Vehicle Cradle
Figure 9.19 Unpowered Vehicle Cradle
The vehicle cradle is available in two versions–unpowered (WA1000) and powered
(WA1010). A port replicator option is available for both types of vehicle cradle.
The vehicle cradle is a highly ruggedized, single station dock. Although it provides
quick insertion and removal, the cradle holds the WORKABOUT PRO securely
even when operated in high vibration environments.
9.10.1 Vehicle Cradle Mounting Recommendations
Warning:
Before mounting a vehicle cradle in a vehicle, there are a number
of operator safety issues that require careful attention. An improperly mounted cradle may result in one or more of the following:
operator injury, operator visibility obstruction, operator distraction
and/or poor ease of egress for the operator. Psion Teklogix strongly
recommends that you seek professional mounting advice from the
vehicle manufacturer.
Cable routing within a vehicle cab also requires careful consideration, especially for separately tethered scanners and other devices
with loose cables. If you are unable to obtain suitable advice,
contact Psion Teklogix for assistance (see Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices). Note also that for better protection,
the equipment should be mounted inside the vehicle roll cage.
298 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Mounting Template
Pedestal mounts are recommended for all fixed mount locations because they offer
optimal operator access. In addition, for safety reasons, only pedestal mounts with
fully locking joints should be used in vehicles. Always adjust the pedestal for the
optimum viewing angle, and securely tighten the hex and wing screws.
The most effective way to mount the vehicle cradle is to use the four #8-32 threaded inserts
on the rear of the unit. Bolts must not extend more than 10mm (3/8") into the cradle.
To accommodate the service loop of the connector cable, leave a 4" clearance at the
bottom of the cradle. Leave a 7" (minimum) clearance at the top of the cradle to
allow easy removal of the hand-held. Also remember to leave at least a 3" clearance
at the sides of the cradle to allow activation of the release knobs. Refer to the
detailed assembly instructions that are packaged with the cradle when selecting a
mounting location.
9.10.1.1 Mounting Template
The vehicle cradle is shipped with detailed mounting instructions including a drill template.
9.10.2 Wiring Guidelines
Before installing cables between the cradle and other devices, review the following:
• Ensure that drilling holes will not damage the vehicle or its wiring.
• Protect cable runs from pinching, overheating and physical damage.
• Use grommets to protect cables that pass through metal.
• Use plastic straps and tie-downs to secure cables and connectors in their
desired location, away from areas where they may get snagged or pulled.
• Keep cables away from heat sources, grease, battery acid and other
potential hazards.
• Keep cables away from control pedals and other moving parts that may
damage the cables or interfere with the operation of the vehicle.
9.10.3 Using The Vehicle Cradle
If your WORKABOUT PRO is equipped with a shoulder strap or cover, these
accessories need to be removed before installing the unit in a vehicle cradle. There is
no need to remove handstraps, pistol grips or tethered devices from the unit.
• Slide the WORKABOUT PRO into the cradle, and press firmly downward
until it locks into place. On a vehicle, it’s a good idea to pull up on the
WORKABOUT PRO to be certain that it is secure.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 299
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Maintaining The Vehicle Cradle
•
To remove the unit, press firmly on the RELEASE button on the front face
of the unit until it releases from it latch. The hand-held will be slightly
raised so that it can be removed.
9.10.4 Maintaining The Vehicle Cradle
Two latches in the cradle hold the WORKABOUT PRO firmly in place. Although
these latches are designed for robustness and endurance, they will wear over time
and will no longer lock the hand-held securely in the cradle. For replacement parts
and instructions contact Psion Teklogix. Partial disassembly is required.
9.10.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles
Warning:
Voltages exceeding 60VDC are considered hazardous. For powered
cradle installations on vehicles with batteries above this voltage,
ensure the powered cradle power connector is mounted in a dry
location on the vehicle, or that the connector is insulated with an
appropriate waterproof material after installation. The connector
must also be installed out of the vehicle operator’s reach. Exposing
an accessible power connector to water or other liquids could create
a hazardous situation resulting in serious injury or death.
Installation of powered cradles in vehicles that operate above 60VDC require
special consideration.
Due to the hazardous voltages present on these vehicles, it is necessary to ensure
that the powered cradle power supply cable connector is not accessible to the
vehicle operator, and does not get exposed to water or other liquids. This can be
accomplished in one of the following ways:
• Ensure the power connector is installed in a dry location on the vehicle,
away from the vehicle operator’s reach (perhaps under a vehicle dash or in a
sealed housing).
• Cover the power connector with a waterproof heat shrink material.
• Wrap the connector securely with a waterproof electrical tape in an area out
of the vehicle operators reach.
All other installation requirements outlined in this document should also be
followed for High Voltage vehicles to insure safe installation and operation of the
powered cradle.
300 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Powered Vehicle Cradle Installation
9.10.6 Powered Vehicle Cradle Installation
The powered cradle option is designed to allow the WORKABOUT PRO to be
powered by a vehicle battery. The battery installed in the hand-held is also recharged
by the vehicle battery. This option accepts DC power sources ranging from 10 to
55V, with optional pre-regulator.
The vehicle cradle can be ordered with the powered cradle option installed.
Warning:
Applying a voltage greater than that specified or reversing or
reversing polarity may result in permanent damage to the cradle
power option and will void the product warranty.
9.10.6.1 Wiring Vehicle Power To The Cradle
A 1.8 meter (6 foot) extension power cable (PN 13985) is supplied with your
powered vehicle cradle. This cable should be wired to a filtered, fused (maximum
10A) accessory supply on the vehicle. The power cradle draws no more than 8A
(less if the accessory supply is greater than 12V). Any additional wiring, connectors
or disconnects used should be rated for at least 10A.
The red lead of the power cable attaches to the positive vehicle supply. The black
lead connects to the negative supply–this should be connected to a proper terminal
block and not to the vehicle body. The power cradle is fully isolated and can be used
with both negative and positive chassis vehicles.
You may have the option of connecting power before or after the ‘key’ switch. It is
preferable to wire the power cradle after the key switch–that is, it cannot be turned
on without the key on. However, if the operator switches the key off repeatedly for
long periods during a shift, it may make more sense to wire the cradle before the
switch.
Keep in mind that the WORKABOUT PRO will continue to operate with or without
vehicle power as long as its battery has sufficient charge.
If an unfused power source must be used, a fuse assembly (PN 19440) must be
added to the extension power cable (the fuse and instructions are supplied with the
cable). Use only a 10A slow blow UL approved fuse in the fuse assembly.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 301
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
The Port Replicator
9.10.7 The Port Replicator
Figure 9.20 Port Replicator
The port replicator (Model# WA4005) is an optional accessory that allows tethered
devices as well as mounted peripherals (e.g., bar code printers or weigh scales) to be
attached to the vehicle cradle. The replicator can be used with or without the cradle
power option.
The functionality of the WORKABOUT PRO tether port is replicated into RS-232
serial interfaces by the port replicator. It provides the user with 3 DB9 serial
interfaces as well as one Type B USB port (for connecting a Host device).
9.11 Bluetooth Peripherals
The WORKABOUT PRO C (a unit equipped with a colour display)–comes
equipped with a Bluetooth radio, making it is possible to communicate with a
variety of Bluetooth peripherals, including GSM/GPRS handsets, scanners, printers,
and so on.
The range of the Bluetooth radio is limited to approximately 5 meters.
Psion Teklogix provides built-in support for the Bluetooth peripherals listed below.
• GSM/GPRS universal handset
• Bluetooth printer
Keep in mind that Bluetooth and IEEE 802.11b radios both operate in the 2.4GHz
band. Although the WORKABOUT PRO includes features to minimize
interference, performance of the system will not be optimal if you use both radios
simultaneously. Typically, when both radios operate in the hand-held at the same
time, they cannot transmit simultaneously–this has a negative impact on overall
302 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 9: Peripheral Devices & Accessories
Bluetooth Peripherals
system throughput. To minimize the impact on the backbone 802.11b network,
Psion Teklogix recommends using Bluetooth peripherals that have low transaction
rates (such as printers and scanners).
Refer to “Bluetooth Setup” on page 172 for information about setting up your Bluetooth devices for communication. In addition, review the manual shipped with your
Bluetooth device to determine the method used to associate with the WORKABOUT PRO host.
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 303
10
SPECIFICATIONS
10.1 Hand-Held Computer Specifications . . . . . . . .
10.2 Radio Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3 Scanner Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.3.1 SE 1223HP Scanner Specifications . . . . .
10.3.2 SE 923HP Scanner Specifications . . . . . .
10.3.3 E1022 Linear 1D Imager Scanner . . . . . .
10.3.4 Symagery SX5390 Advanced Imager . . . .
10.4 Battery Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.1 Standard Battery Pack . . . . . . . . . . . .
10.4.2 High-Capacity Battery Pack . . . . . . . . .
10.4.3 Maxell ML2032 Rechargeable Coin Battery .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
307
309
309
309
310
311
312
313
313
314
316
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
305
Chapter 10: Specifications
Hand-Held Computer Specifications
Note:
Performance specifications are nominal and subject to change
without notice.
10.1 Hand-Held Computer Specifications
WORKABOUT PRO C Models
Size
•
•
•
Length: 8.7" (221mm)
Width: 3" (76mm) at grip area tapering to 3.6" (92mm) at display area.
Depth: 1.2" (31mm) at grip area tapering to 1.7" (44mm) at display area.
Weight
With battery: 16 oz. (454g); add 2.6 oz. (75g) with SE 1223HP scanner expansion module; add 0.7 oz. (19g) with 802.11b CF card radio.
WORKABOUT PRO S Model
Size
•
•
•
Length: 7.5” (190mm)
Width: 2.9” (75mm) at grip area tapering to 3.8" (98mm) at display area
(including side scan buttons)
Depth: 1.2" (31mm) at grip area tapering to 1.7" (44mm) at display area
Weight
With battery: 16 oz. (454g); add 2.6 oz. (75g) with SE 1223HP scanner expansion module; add 0.7 oz. (19g) with 802.11b CF card radio.
WORKABOUT PRO C And S Models
Operating System
Microsoft Windows Mobile 2003 SE
Processor
•
Intel Xscale PXA255
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 307
Chapter 10: Specifications
Hand-Held Computer Specifications
Power Management
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
3.8V Standard Capacity Li-ion rechargeable battery - up to 8 hours of operation.
3.8V High-Capacity Li-ion rechargeable battery - up to 12 hours of
operation.
Advanced Smart Battery w/ gas gauge.
Quick swap battery packs.
Built-in fast charger.
Rechargeable, user-replacable internal coin battery.
Also accepts 3 AA Alkaline batteries.
Communication
Ports
USB Host port on base for tethered USB devices
(printers, etc.)
Low Insertion Force Docking Station Port with:
- USB Device Port
- USB Host port
- Power in/out
Environmental
Operating Temperature
Storage Temperature
Rain And Dust Resistance
Humidity
Shock
14°F to 122°F (-10°C to +50°C)
-13°F to 140°F (-25°C to +60°C)
IEC 529, classification IP54.
5% - 95% RH non-condensing
Multiple 4 ft. (1.2m) drops to polished concrete.
Approvals
Safety
EMC
Laser
Bluetooth:
In-Vehicle Cradle
UL60950-1, CSA C22.2
No 60950-1
FCC Part 15 Class B
EN 55022
EN 55024
IEC 60825-1, Class 2
FDA 21 CFR 1040.10,
1040.11 Class II
1.1 on C & S models
E Mark
308 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 10: Specifications
Radio Specifications
10.2 Radio Specifications
802.11b Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum
Transmit Power
50mW max for EU countries
Frequency Range
2.400-2.484GHz for EU
Channels
Data Rates
100mW max for USA
2.400-2.474 for USA, Canada
1 to 11 for USA, Canada
1-13 for EU countries
1-13 or 14 for Japan
1,2,5.5 and 11Mbps
10.3 Scanner Specifications
10.3.1 SE 1223HP Scanner Specifications
Physical
Characteristics
Dimensions:
Weight:
SE 1223HP (Decoded)
0.76 in. max. H x 1.51 in. max. W x 1.38 in. max. D
1.93 cm max. H x 3.84 cm max. W x 3.51 cm max. D
1.33 oz. max. (37.7 gm max.)
Performance Characteristics
Light Source:
Scan Rate:
Scan Angle:
Scan Patterns:
Minimum Print Contrast:
Symbologies:
Programmable Parameters:
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm
35 (± 5) scans/sec (bidirectional)
42º ± 2º
Linear
Minimum 20% absolute dark/light reflectance measured at 650 nm
UPC/EAN, Code 128, Code 39, Code 93, I 2 of 5,
Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI UCC/EAN 128, TriOptic Code 39
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Power Mode, Trigger
Mode, Bidirectional Redundancy, Symbology
types/lengths, Data Formatting, Serial Parameters,
Beeper Tone
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 309
Chapter 10: Specifications
SE 923HP Scanner Specifications
12 position ZIF connector. Symbol Standard SSI
Interface with logic level serial data communications
plus trigger, beeper and decode LED signals
Interfaces:
User Environment
Ambient Light, Artificial:
Ambient Light, Sunlight:
Operating Temperature:
Storage Temperature:
Humidity:
Power, Input Voltage:
Power, Input Current:
Power, Standby Current:
Shock:
450 ft. candles (4,844 lux)
10,000 ft. candles (107,640 lux)
-22° F to 140° F (-30° C to 60° C)
-40° F to 140° F (-40° C to 60° C)
5% to 95% noncondensing
5.0 VDC ± 10%
110 mA typical
130 µA max.
2,000 G
Regulatory
Intended for use in CDRH Class II and IEC Class 2
devices
UL, VDE, and CUL recognized component laser
Laser Classification:
Electrical Safety:
Figure 10.1 SE 1223 Scanner
10.3.2 SE 923HP Scanner Specifications
Parameter
Light Source
Scan Rate
Scan Angle
Scan Patterns
Minimum Print Contrast
Symbologies
Programmable Parameters
Ambient Light:
Operating Temperature:
Storage Temperature:
SE 923
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm
39 (± 3) scans/sec (bi-directional)
53º (typical)
Linear
Minimum 25% absolute
dark/light reflectance measured at 650 nm
UPC/EAN, Code 128, Code 39, Code 93, I 2
of 5, Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI Plessey
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Power Mode,
Trigger Mode, Bi-directional Redundancy,
Symbology types/lengths, Data formatting,
Serial Parameters, Beeper Tone Scan Angle
Artificial: 450 ft. candles (4844 Lux)
Sunlight: 10000 ft. candles (107,640 Lux)
-4º to 131ºF (-20º to 55ºC) chassis temperature
-40° to 140°F (-40° to 60°C)
310 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 10: Specifications
E1022 Linear 1D Imager Scanner
Parameter
Humidity:
Power:
Input Voltage:
Input Current:
Standby Current:
Shock
Output Power (peak)
SE 923
5% to 95% noncondensing
3.0-5.5 VDC ± 10%
65 mA typical
8 µA max
2000 G
0.94mW
Figure 10.2 SE 923 Scanner
10.3.3 E1022 Linear 1D Imager Scanner
Parameter
Optics
Sensor
Scan Rate
Scan Angle
Skew and Pitch
Min. x Dimension
Depth of Field
Bar Code Width
Print Contrast
Symbologies
Programmable
Parameters
Interfaces
Ambient Light
Operating Temperature
E1022
645 nm visible red top LED
Bright and sharp scanning line
CCD linear image sensor
270 scans/s auto-adaptive
48°
+/-35°
Down to 0.05 mm (2mil)
0 to 49.2 cm (19.4'')
up to 18 cm (7'') on 0.3
Down to 20%
UPC (E&A), EAN, Code 39, Code 128, UCC EAN
128, ISBN, Interleaved, Matrix, Industrial and Standard 2 of 5, Codabar, Code 93, MSI, Plessey,
Telepen. Others including ISBT on request.
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Power Mode, Trigger
Mode, Bi-directional Redundancy, Symbology
types/lengths, Data formatting, Serial Parameters,
Beeper Tone, Scan Angle
Decoded: RS232 TTL
Works in any lighting
conditions, from 0 to 100 000 lux
0 to 50°C (32 to 122°F)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 311
Chapter 10: Specifications
Symagery SX5390 Advanced Imager
Parameter
Storage Temperature
Humidity
Power
Shock
E1022
-25 to 70°C (-11 to 160°F)
5% to 95% (non-condensing)
Voltage: +5VDC +-5%
Current: 140 mA typical
Standby current: 40µA
Withstands multiple 1m (3') drops on concrete
Figure 10.3 E1022 Decoded 1D Imager Scanner
10.3.4 Symagery SX5390 Advanced Imager
Parameter
Optical Resolution
Field of View at 6 inches
Pitch Angle
Skew Angle
Ambient Light
Minimum Contrast
Targeting
Decode Software Suites and
Symbologies supported
Power supply
Operating Temperature
Relative Humidity
SX5390
1.0 megapixel (1024 x 1024)
5.12" x 5.12"
±45°
±45°
Total darkness to 100,000 lux (full sunlight)
10%
Intuitive range finding 626 nm LED
Linear: Code 39; Code 39 Full ASCII; UPC-A, -A2,
-A5; UPC-E, -E2, -E5; EAN-8 -13; JAN; I2of5;
Code 128; Codabar/NW7; RSS 14, RSS Limited,
RSS Expanded, RSS 14 Truncated
PDF417 plus: (as above) + PDF417, microPDF417;
Composite, CC-A, CC-B, CC-C; image capture and
signature capture
Matrix plus: (as above) + Data Matrix; QR Code;
Maxicode; Aztec Code; Planet; Postnet; Royal Mail
4SCC; 4 State postal codes from Australia, Canada,
Japan; Korean Post 3of5
3.6 Volt DC nominal (2.7 - 5 Volts DC)
(direct lithium supply)
-20° to 50 C (-4 to 122° F)
5% to 95% (non-condensing)
312 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 10: Specifications
Battery Specifications
Parameter
Storage Temperature
Shock
Weight
Connectivity
SX5390
-30 to 60° C (-22° to 140° F)
15 drops, 5 ft to concrete at room temperature
when integrated correctly into end-user packaging
12 grams
USB 1.1 or serial async
Figure 10.4 SX5390 Imager
10.4 Battery Specifications
10.4.1 Standard Battery Pack
Chemistry Capacity
Voltage
Cell Configuration
Cell Type
Max. Discharge Current
Charge Algorithm
Max. Charge Voltage
Max. Charge Current
Discharge Cut-off
Recommended
Fast Charge
Max. Fast Charge Time
Recommended Termination Taper Current
Recommended Charge
Termination Timeout
Charge Temperature
Discharge Temperature
Recommended Termination Taper Current
Recommended Charge
Termination Timeout
Charge Temperature
Discharge Temperature
Lithium Ion Polymer Battery (Li-Polymer)
1750 mAh nominal at 350mA discharge 20 °C (68° F) to
2.8V(minimum)
3.7V nominal (2.8V min. to 4.2V max.)
1S2P (2 parallel connected cells)
Lithium-ion Polymer Battery
1A (-10° C to 60° C) -- (14° F to 140° F)
CC to CV
4.2V +/- 0.05V
800 mA
2.6V min – DS2761 protection circuit initiates
1550 mA for 2.5hrs
3.0 hrs.
50 - 100 mA
30 min.
0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F)
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F)
50 - 100 mA
30 min.
0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F)
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 313
Chapter 10: Specifications
High-Capacity Battery Pack
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F) Storing battery at elevated
temperatures is not recommended.
300 cycles minimum with no degradation below 80% of
Cycle Life
nominal capacity based on standard charge / standard discharge
rates (to 2.8V) @ 25ºC
Impedance
45m¾ max. @ 1kHz AC only the battery cell
200 m ¾max., fully charged new pack (including cell resisTotal Internal Resistance
tance and protection circuit resistance) @ 1kHz AC
>60% nominal capacity after 20 days @ 60° C (full charge) -High Temperature
Recovery
(140° F)
>80% nominal capacity after 72 hours @ -20° C (full charge) Low Temperature
Recovery
- (-4° F)
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F) >80% capacity recovery
within 1 month
-20° C to 45° C (-4° F to 113° F) >75% capacity recovery
Capacity recovery
within 3 month
-20° C to 20° C (-4° F to 68° F) >70% capacity recovery within
1 year
Storage Temperature
10.4.2 High-Capacity Battery Pack
Lithium Ion Polymer Battery (Li-Polymer)
Chemistry Capacity
2625 mAh nominal at 350mA discharge 20 °C (68° F) to
2.8V(minimum)
1800 mAh nominal at 300mA discharge at –20 °C to
2.8V (minimum)
Voltage
3.7V nominal (2.8V min. to 4.2V max.)
Cell Configuration
1S3P (3 parallel connected cells)
Cell Type
Lithium-ion Polymer Battery
Max. Discharge
Current
1.7A (-10° C to 60° C) -- (14° F to 140° F)
0.5C (-20° C to 60° C) -- (-4° F to 140° F)
Charge Algorithm
CC to CV
Max. Charge Voltage
4.2V +/- 0.05V
Max. Charge Current
900 mA
Discharge Cut-off
2.6V min – DS2761 protection circuit initiates
Recommended
Fast Charge
2325 mA for 4.0 hrs
314 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Chapter 10: Specifications
High-Capacity Battery Pack
Max. Fast Charge Time 5.0 hrs
Recommended Termination Taper Current
50 - 100 mA
Recommended Charge
Termination Timeout
30 min.
Charge Temperature
0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F)
Discharge Temperature
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F)
Recommended Termination Taper Current
50 - 100 mA
Recommended Charge
Termination Timeout
30 min.
Charge Temperature
0° C to 45 °C (32° F to 113° F)
Discharge Temperature
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F)
Storage Temperature
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F) Storing battery at elevated
temperatures is not recommended.
Cycle Life
300 cycles minimum with no degradation below 80% of
nominal capacity based on standard charge / standard discharge
rates (to 2.8V) @ 25ºC
Impedance
35m¾ max. @ 1kHz AC only the battery cell
Total Internal Resistance
210 m ¾max., fully charged new pack (including cell resistance and protection circuit resistance) @ 1kHz AC
High Temperature
Recovery
>60% nominal capacity after 20 days @ 60° C (full charge) -(140° F)
Low Temperature
Recovery
>80% nominal capacity after 72 hours @ -20° C (full charge) - (-4° F)
Capacity recovery
-20° C to 60° C (-4° F to 140° F) >80% capacity recovery
within 1 month
-20° C to 45° C (-4° F to 113° F) >75% capacity recovery
within 3 month
-20° C to 20° C (-4° F to 68° F) >70% capacity recovery within
1 year
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual 315
Chapter 10: Specifications
Maxell ML2032 Rechargeable Coin Battery
10.4.3 Maxell ML2032 Rechargeable Coin Battery
Model
ML2032
System
Lithium Ion
Nominal Voltage (V)
3V
Nominal Capacity (mAh*)
65
Nominal Discharge Current
(µA)
200
Depth of Discharge = 10%
1,000 (6.5 mAh discharge) (total capacity 6,500 mAh)
Depth of Discharge = 20%
300 (13 mAh discharge) (total capacity 3,900 mAh)
Temperature Ranges
Operating
-10° C to 60° C (14° F to 140° F)
* Nominal capacity indicates duration until the voltage drops down to 2.0V when
discharged at a nominal discharge current at 20° C (68° F).
316 Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
APPENDIX
A
SUPPORT SERVICES AND WORLDWIDE OFFICES
Psion Teklogix provides a complete range of product support services to its customers worldwide. These services include technical support and product repairs.
A.1 Technical Support
Technical Support for Mobile Computing Products is provided via e-mail through
the Psion Teklogix customer and partner extranets. To reach the website, go to
www.psionteklogix.com and click on the appropriate Teknet link on the home page.
Then click on the “Log-in” button or the “Register” button, depending on whether
you have previously registered for Teknet. Once you have logged in, search for the
“Support Request Form”.
A.2 Product Repairs
International
For technical support outside of Canada or the U.S.A., please contact your local
Psion Teklogix office listed on our worldwide website:
http://www.psionteklogix.com
Click on the heading labelled ‘Contacts’ to choose a Psion Teklogix technical
support representative closest to you.
Canada/U.S.A
Canadian and U.S. customers can receive access to repair services, by calling the
toll-free number below, or via our secure website (see Technical Support, above).
Note:
Customers calling the toll-free number should have their Psion Teklogix
customer number or trouble ticket number available.
Voice:
1 800 387-8898 (press option ‘2’)
Fax:
1 905 812-6304
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
A-1
A.3 Worldwide Offices
COMPANY HEADQUARTERS
AND CANADIAN SERVICE CENTRE
NORTH AMERICAN HEADQUARTERS
AND U.S. SERVICE CENTRE
Psion Teklogix Inc.Psion Teklogix Corp.
2100 Meadowvale Boulevard
Mississauga
Ontario
Canada L5N 7J9
1810 Airport Exchange Boulevard
Suite 500
Erlanger, Kentucky
USA 41018
Tel:
Fax:
Tel:
Fax:
+1 905 813 9900
+1 905 812 6300
E-mail: [email protected]
+1 859 371 6006
+1 859 371 6422
E-mail: [email protected]
INTERNATIONAL SUBSIDIARIES (see also www.psionteklogix.com)
Psion Teklogix S.A.
La Duranne
135 Rue Rene Descartes
BP 421000
13591 Aix-En-Provence
Cedex 3; France
Tel:
Fax:
+33 4 42 90 88 09
+33 4 42 90 88 88
E-mail: [email protected]
A-2
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
APPENDIX
B
PORT PINOUTS
B.1 Standard Battery Contact Pin Definition
PIN #
Signal
Name
Description
1
P+
Power Pin for Battery Pack Positive
2
P+
Power Pin for Battery Pack Positive
3
DQ
One-wire Interface Data Pin
4
T
GND
5
P-
Power Pin for Battery Pack Negative
6
P-
Power Pin for Battery Pack Negative
7
PS
Power Switch Sense Pin
B.2 High-Capacity Battery Contact Pin Definition
PIN #
Signal
Name
Description
1
P-
Power Pin for Battery Pack Negative
2
DQ
One-wire Interface Data Pin
3
T
GND
4
P+
Power Pin for Battery Pack Positive
5
PS
Power Switch Sense Pin
–
–
Plastic Rib
6
P-
Power Pin for Battery Pack Negative
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
B-1
Appendix B: Port Pinouts
LIF (Low Insertion Force) Port Pinout
B.3 LIF (Low Insertion Force) Port Pinout
PIN #
Signal Name
1
Ground
2
Ground
3
USB Host Data Plus, For connecting USB devices
4
USB Host Data Minus, For connecting USB Devices
5
USB Host Power, for powering USB devices (5V, 100mA Max)
6
DC Power in, for supplying power to WORKABOUT PRO / charging
battery (5V, 3A)
7
DC Power in, for supplying power to WORKABOUT PRO / charging
battery (5V, 3A)
8
LIF Detect, determines if a device is attached to the LIF
9
USB Device Data Minus, for operating the WORKABOUT PRO as a
USB device
10
USB Device Data Plus, for operating the WORKABOUT PRO as a
USB device
11
Ground
12
Ground
B.4 Tether Port Pinout
PIN #
B-2
Signal Name
1
Ground
2
USB Host Data Plus, For connecting USB Devices
3
USB Host Data Minus, For connecting USB Devices
4
USB Host Power, for powering USB devices (5V, 100mA Max)
5
TX Data } TX Data and RX Data are only available on terminals with no
internal Bluetooth
6
RX Data }
7
Tether Detect, determines if a device is attached to the Tether port
8
DC Power In, for supplying power to WORKABOUT PRO / charging
battery (5V, 3A)
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Appendix B: Port Pinouts
Audio Mini-Plug
PIN #
Signal Name
9
DC Power In, for supplying power to WORKABOUT PRO / charging
battery (5V, 3A)
10
DC Power In, for supplying power to WORKABOUT PRO / charging
battery (5V, 3A)
11
Not used.
12
Not used.
13
Not used.
14
Not used.
15
Not used.
16
Ground
17
Ground
18
Ground
B.5 Audio Mini-Plug
Ring 1
Terminal 3
Ring 2
Terminal 1
Sleeve
Terminal 6
Tip
Terminal 2
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
B-3
INDEX
A
About Device icon 99
About icon (software version) 99
accessories
belt loop (carrying case) 277
carrying case 276
cigarette lighter adaptor 297
desktop docking station 284
Ethernet adaptor cable 288
hand strap 273
holster, soft shell 279
pistol grip 275
port replicator 302
quad battery charger 290
quad docking station 292
single battery charger 289
swivel belt loop (carrying case) 277
tether cable & wall adaptor 295
vehicle cradle 298
wall adaptor & tether cable 295
ActiveSync 17, 287
options 182
scheduling synchronization 182
setting up 181
ActiveSync, CD installation 16
AC wall adaptor 295
adaptor cable
AC wall adaptor 295
tether 295
USB-Ethernet 288
adaptor cable, Ethernet 288
Addendum 130
aiming dot, duration of 112, 132
alarm, setting 47
alarms, setting 103
aligning (calibrating) touchscreen 36
aligning (recalibrating) touchscreen 36
ALPHA Key 33
ALT Key 30, 33
appending to bar codes
characters 119, 139
appointments, deleting 54
approvals
WORKABOUT PRO (including
scanner) 308
arrow keys
moving the cursor 29, 33
attachments, receiving (Messaging) 205
audio indicators
description of beep conditions 38
volume adjustment using the BLUE
key 38
audio mini-plug, pinouts B-3
authentication, network (Shared Mode) 75
Auto Exposure (Imager) 133
automotive adaptor 297
Aztec 137
B
backlight
Battery Power tab 100
battery power tab 99
External Power tab 100
intensity 36
Intensity tab 101
keyboard 30, 36
backup profile, creating (Total Recall) 155
backup profile, restoring (Total Recall)
157
Bad Scan Beep 139
bar code
appending to 119, 139
Decoded 111
displaying type of bar code 139
Imager 132
Options tab 138
parameters 111–138
prefix character 117, 119
stripping characters 118, 119
suffix character 117, 119
symbologies
Codabar 122, 131, 134
Code 11 131
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
i
Index
Code 128 118, 134
Code 39 133
Code 93 123, 131, 134
Discrete 2 of 5 126, 130
EAN 13 119, 130
EAN 8 119, 129
Interleaved 2 of 5 124, 130, 135
MSI Plessey 125, 131
UPC A 120, 129
UPC E 120, 129
Translation tab 140
batteries
a description of 280
charging 15, 25
installing 23, 24
installing in WORKABOUT 16
internal (ML2032) 15
removing 23
run time, maximizing 39
safety precautions 280
swap time 25
1800 mAh pinout B-1
2700 mAh pinouts B-1
battery charger
safety instructions 282–283
Battery Details tab 107
Battery info. tab 105
battery pack 280–281
battery power, managing 105
Battery Power tab 100
battery safety 280–283
battery See also batteries 280
battery settings 106
Baud Rate (modem setup) 161
beeper
description of beep conditions 38
volume adjustment using the BLUE
key 38
belt loop, swivel (carrying case) 277
Bi-Direction Redundancy 113
BKSP (DEL Key) 29, 33
Block Recognizer 65, 66
Bluetooth setup 172
GPRS setup 175
peripherals 302
Built-In Devices tab 108
Buttons icon 81
ii
C
calculator 185
calendar 52, 185
categories, using 54
deleting appointments 54
reminders, creating 53
calendar entry
creating & editing 53
calibrating (aligning) touchscreen 36
Card Slot tab 107
case, carrying 276
categories (calendar) 54
CD (companion) 16
CDMA/1xRTT 141–153
cells
copying 226
deleting 230
formatting 226
pasting 226
Center Bar Code Only (Imager) 132
certificates 101
characters
appending to bar codes 119
prefix 117, 119
stripping 118, 119
suffix 117, 119
character set, changing (Internet Explorer)
193
charger
descriptions of 25
safety instructions 282–283
chargers 281
desktop docking station 284
installing at a site 282
operator controls 282
quad battery charger (WA3004) 290
single battery 289
charging (battery) 15
check digit 125
Check Digit, One 125
Check Digits (MSI Plessey) 125
Check Digit Verification 116
Check Digit Verification (I 2 of 5) 124
cigarette lighter adaptor 297
Click Data (scanner double-click) 139
Click Time (scanner double-click)
138
clock, setting 47, 103
Clock button 47
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Index
CLSI Editing 123
Codabar 122, 131, 134
Codabar 122
Code 11 131
Code 128 134
Code 128 118, 129
Code 128 Emulation 126
Code 32, Convert To 115
Code 32 Prefix 115
Code 39 115, 129
Code 93 123, 131, 134
Code 93 123
cold reset 18
columns
deleting 230
inserting 229
working with 226
communication
ActiveSync 17, 287
Ethernet connection (desktop dock)
288
Ethernet connection (quad dock) 293
WORKABOUT to PC 17, 287
companion CD 16
Composite 128, 138
connecting to a server with 245
connection, cancelling (modem) 162
Connections 158
editing settings 167
ending 170
Internet 158
managing 167
modem setup 159
network, selecting 169
network cards, setting up 164
Proxy Server setup 170
VPN, setting up 166
connections
managing 166
connectivity Indicator 46
contacts 185
adding 186
categories, assigning 188
categories, creating 187
importing 187
viewing 188
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A 121
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A 121
Convert To Code 32 115
Convert To EAN 13 124
Copyright information, operating system
99
cradle See also Picker cradle 298
credit card, wait for (modem setup) 162
CTRL Key 30, 33
D
Data Bits (modem setup) 162
data entry modes
handwriting 239
recording audio files 240
typing 239
date, setting 47
decoded (internal) scanner parameters 111
decoded Intermec (ISCP) parameters 128
decoded scanner 111
Decode Performance 117, 118
Decode Performance Level 117, 118
DEL (BKSP) Key 29, 33
Delete Char Set ECIs 114
desktop docking station (WA4002) 284
desktop screen (Today’s Screen) 45
Device ID tab 99
Dial-String Commands (modem setup)
162
Dial Tone, wait for (modem setup) 161
digit
check digit 125
Discrete 2 of 5 126, 130
Discrete 2 of 5 126
display
backlight, adjusting 36
docking station
uploading data using 40
docking stations 281
desktop docking station 284
installation at site 282
operator controls 282
quad dock 292
Dot Time 112, 132
double-click
appending characters to a decoded
bar code 139
scanner trigger 138
E
EAN/UCC 128 118
EAN 13 119, 130
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
iii
Index
EAN 8 119, 129
EAN-8 Zero Extend 119
ECI Decoder 115
email notification 49
Enable Bookland (UPC-EAN) 121
Enable CC-AB 128
Enable CC-C 128
Enable RSS Expanded 127
Enable RSS Limited 127
Enable RSS-14 127
Enable TLC-39 128
ESC Key 30, 33
Ethernet card See Network Card 164
Excel See Pocket Excel 222
expansion modules 261
GSM/GPRS module, installing 265
PCMCIA module, installing 263
scanner module, installing 268, 269
External Power tab 100
E1022 1D imager specs 311
F
Fast Converge (Imager) 133
features (of WORKABOUT PRO) 4
fields
Field Size 117
size 117
file, copy 58
file, deleting 59
file, renaming 58
File Explorer 189
copy 58
copying a file 58
deleting file 59
folders, creating 58
renaming file 58
File Explorer, using 57
files & folders, managing 57
Find 189
Flow Control 163
folder, copy 58
folder, creating 58
folder, renaming 58
formulas (Excel)
creating 231
Insert Function Command 233
manually inserting 232
Full ASCII (decoded scanner) 117
Function keys 30, 34
iv
G
Games 181
Good Scan Beep 139
GPRS (bluetooth) 175
GSM/GPRS 141–153
GSM/GPRS module, installing 265
H
hand strap 273
hardware, description of 99
Help 63
helpdesk 4
Help screens, displaying 190
holster, soft shell 279
home page, setting (Internet Explorer)
193, 194
I
Imager 132
imager
E1022 1D imager specs 311
SX5390 2D imager specs 312
imager parameters 132
indicators
LED functions 37
task bar 60
inking settings 92
Input 141
Input Methods 89
Block Recognizer 66, 90
Input Method tab 89
Keyboard Options 90
Letter Recognizer 66, 90
Transcriber 64
Transcriber options 91
input modes 240
handwriting 239
typing 239
Insert Function Command 233
Intensity tab (backlight) 101
Interleaved 2 of 5 124, 130, 135
internal battery (ML2032) 15
Internet connection 158
Internet Explorer 190
browsing web sites 190
character sets, changing 193
home page, setting 193, 194
links, synchronizing 196
security options, changing 192
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Index
storage space, freeing 192, 193
View menu options 191
web sites, organizing 194
ISBT 128 118
removing 24
Low Power Timeout 112
L1, Set Length 116
L2, Set Length 116
K
M
keyboard
one shot mode 82
options 90
Scancode remapping 87
Unicode Mapping 85
keyboard, soft (onscreen) 64
keyboard backlight 30, 36
keyboard keys 27
ALPHA 33
ALT 30, 33
arrow keys 29, 33
BKSP 29, 33
CTRL 30, 33
DEL 29, 33
ESC 30, 33
Function keys 30, 34
Macro keys 30
macro keys 84
modifiers 28, 32
one shot mode 82
PgDn 33
PgUp 33
SCAN 30, 34
Scancode Remapping 87
SHIFT 29, 33
SPACE 30, 33
TAB 30, 33
Unicode Mapping 85
L
Laser On Time 112
LED
functions (WORKABOUT) 37
Letter Recognizer 67
Letter Recognizer options (Input Methods
tab) 90
LIF (Low Insert Force) port pinout B-2
Linear Decode 122
Linear Security Level 112
links, synchronizing (Internet Explorer)
196
Lithium-Ion batteries
installing 24
Macro keys 30
deleting a macro 85
executing a macro 85
Macros menu, accessing 84
recording and saving 84
mail server accounts (Messaging) 200
maintenance (WORKABOUT) 42
mapping
Scancode 87
Unicode 85
Max Gain (Imager) 133
Max Illumination (Imager) 133
Max Integration (Imager) 133
Media Play controls 258
Media Play See Windows Media 247
Memory
amount available 103
Running Programs 104
Storage Card tab 104
menus
menu bar 59
New menu, customizing 95
pop-up 60
Start menu, customizing 94
using 59
messages
Scan Indicator 139
scanner warning message 139
Scan Result 139
Messaging 197
attachments, receiving 205
creating 206
deleting 206
file, attaching 206
folders 197
forwarding 204
mail server accounts 200
Outlook email, synchronizing 198
remote server, downloading from 203
replying to 204
sending 206
mini-plug, audio pinout B-3
modem setup 159
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
v
Index
advanced settings 161
Baud Rate 161
Cancel If Not Connected 162
Dial-String Commands 162
Server Settings 164
TCP_IP Settings 163
Wait For Credit Card 162
Wait For Dial Tone 161
modifier keys 28, 32
locking 28, 32
One Shot Mode 82
unlocking 28, 32
MSI Plessey 125, 131
MSN Messenger 208
account, setting up 208
contacts, adding 210
getting started 208
privacy, managing 211
signing in 209
signing out 210
music, playing 255
N
name, assigning to WORKABOUT PRO
99
navigation bar 46
Clock button 47
Connectivity button 46
Start button 46
Volume button 47
network, selecting 169
network authentication (Shared Mode) 75
network card
settings, changing 165
setting up 164
New menu, customizing 55, 56, 95
Note
creating 213
recording a message (audio) 215
renaming 215
synchronizing 216
text, converting handwriting into 213
Notes 212
Notification, setting 96
NOTIS Editing 123
O
Off & On buttons 16, 26
offices list 4
vi
On & Off button 16, 26
One Check Digit 125
One Shot Mode 82
One Shot tab (modifier keys) 82
onscreen (soft) keyboard 64
Options tab (bar codes) 138
Outlook, CD installation 16
Outlook email, synchronizing (Messaging)
198
Output 141
Owner Information 95
ownership information, defining 49
P
Parameter Scanning 112
Parity 163
password, setting 96
PC, connecting WORKABOUT to 17, 287
PCMCIA module, installing 263
PgDn Key 33
PgUp Key 33
picker cradle
installing cable 299
Pictures 217
brightness, adjusting 219
contrast, adjusting 219
cropping 220
deleting 219
editing 219
opening 218
slide show, creating 221
zoom in & out 220
pinouts B-1
pistol grip 275
Pocket Excel 222
cells, working with 226
columns, inserting 229
columns, working with 226
deleting cells, rows & columns 230
formulas, creating 231
rows, inserting 229
rows, working with 226
workbook components 223
worksheets, moving between 223
worksheets, working with 224
Pocket Word 235
cutting, copying & pasting 242
data entry modes 239
document, creating 236
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Index
document, opening 237
document, reverting to saved 238
document, saving 238
finding text 243
paragraphs, adjusting 242
replacing text 244
templates, using 236
text, formatting 241
toolbar, using 241
undoing actions 243
port pinouts B-1
port replicator 302
ports
Data Bits 162
Flow Control (modem setup) 163
LIF (Low Insertion Force) B-2
Parity (modem setup) 163
Stop Bits (modem setup) 163
Terminal (modem setup) 163
tether B-2
Postal
PlaNET 135
PostNET 136
Royal 136
Power 105
Advanced battery settings 106
Battery Details tab 107
Battery tab 105
Built-In Devices 108
Card Slot tab 107
On Battery Power 106
On External Power 106
Wireless tab 105
power up 16
Prefix 114
Prefix Char 117, 119
profile, creating backup 155
profile, restoring backup 157
Programs 61, 181
closing 62
minimizing 61
opening 61
properties, WORKABOUT PRO 99
protective case 276
proxy server, setting up 170
punctuation marks, accessing (ALPHA
Key) 33
punctuation marks, accessing (SHIFT
Key) 29, 33
Q
quad battery charger 290
quad dock (WA4004) 292
R
radio
configuring
authentication, network 75
network authentication 75
radio specifications 309
Raster 114
Raster Expand Rate, 2D 114
Raster Height, 2D 114
recording audio files 240
Regional Settings 108
remapping
Scancode 87
Unicode 85
reminders (calendar) 53
remote server, downloading from
(Messaging) 203
Remove Programs 109
reset (WORKABOUT PRO) 17
resetting the WORKABOUT
cold reset 18
warm reset 17
rows
deleting 230
inserting 229
working with 226
Running Programs
activating 104
stopping (programs) 104
S
safety instructions
battery charger 282–283
Scancode remapping 87
Scan Data Format 114
Scan Indicator 139
SCAN Key 30, 34
Scan Log File 140
scanner
aiming (target) dot duration 112, 132
appending data 139
Auto Exposure (Imager) 133
Aztec 137
Bad Scan Beep 139
bar code, appending data to 139
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
vii
Index
bar code settings (internal) 110
Bi-Direction Redundancy 113
Center Bar Code Only (Imager) 132
Check Digits (MSI Plessey) 125
Check Digit Verification 116, 124
Click Data (appending data) 139
Click Time (double-click) 138
CLSI Editing 123
Codarbar 122
Code 128 118, 129
Code 128 Emulation 126
Code 32 Prefix 115
Code 39 115, 129
Code 93 123
Composite 128, 138
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A 121
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A 121
Convert To Code 32 115
Convert To EAN 13 124
decoded (internal) 111
decoded Intermec (ISCP) 128
Decode Perf. Level 117, 118
Decode Performance 117, 118
Delete Char Set ECIs 114
Discrete 2 of 5 126
Dot Time 112, 132
double-click 138
EAN-8 Zero Extend 119
ECI Decoder 115
Enable Bookland 121
Enable CC-AB 128
Enable CC-C 128
Enable RSS Expanded 127
Enable RSS Limited 127
Enable RSS-14 127
Enable TLC-39 128
E1022 linear 1D imager specs 311
Fast Converge (Imager) 133
Full ASCII 117
Good Scan Beep 139
imager 132
Laser On Time 112
Linear Decode 122
Linear Security Level 112
Low Power Timeout 112
Max Gain (Imager) 133
Max Illumination (Imager) 133
Max Integration (Imager) 133
NOTIS Editing 123
Options tab 132, 138
viii
Parameter Scanning 112
Postal
PlaNET 135
PostNET 136
Royal 136
Prefix 114
Scan Data Format 114
Scan Log File 140
Scan Result Time 139
Security Level 122
Set Length L1 116
Set Length L2 116
Suffix 114
Supp. Redundancy 122
Supplementals 121
SX5390 2D imager specs 312
target dot duration 112, 132
Tranmsit Check Digit (MSI Plessey)
125
Translations tab 140
Transmit Check Digit 116, 124
Transmit Check Digit (MSI Plessey)
125
Transmit Code 1D Char 114
Trioptic Code 39, Enable 115
UPC-A Check Digit 120
UPC-A Preamble 120
UPC-EANI 121, 134
UPC-EAN Shared Settings 130
UPC-E Check Digit 120
UPC-E Preamble 121
UPC-E1 Check Digit 120
UPC-E1 Preamble 121
warning message 139
2D DataMatrix 136
2D Maxicode 136
2D Micro PDF-417 126, 137
2D PDF-417 126, 137
2D QR Code 137
2D Raster Expand Rate 114
2D Raster Height 114
2D RSS Code 127, 137
2D Scanning Mode 113
2D UPC Half Block Stitching 122
scanner module (SE1223 HP)
specs 309
scanner module (SE1223 HP-I00A)
installing 268, 269
scanner module (SE923 HP)
specs 310
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Index
scanning
aiming (target) dot duration 112, 132
appending characters 119, 139
Auto Exposure (Imager) 133
Aztec 137
Bad Scan Beep 139
bar code settings 110
Bi-Direction Redundancy 113
Center Bar Code Only (Imager) 132
check digit 125
Check Digits (MSI Plessey) 125
Check Digit Verification 116
Check Digit Verification (I 2 of 5) 124
Click Data (appending data) 139
Click Time 138
CLSI Editing 123
Codabar 122
Code 128 118, 129
Code 128 Emulation 126
Code 32 Prefix 115
Code 39 115, 129
Code 93 123
Composite 128, 138
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A 121
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A 121
Convert To Code 32 115
Convert To EAN 13 124
decoded (internal) 111
decoded Intermec (ISCP) 128
Decode Perf. Level 117, 118
Decode Performance 117, 118
Delete Char Set ECIs 114
Discrete 2 of 5 126
Dot Time 112, 132
double-click 138
EAN-8 Zero Extend 119
ECI Decoder 115
Enable Bookland 121
Enable CC-AB 128
Enable CC-C 128
Enable RSS Expanded 127
Enable RSS Limited 127
Enable RSS-14 127
Enable TLC-39 128
Fast Converge (Imager) 133
Full ASCII 117
Good Scan Beep 139
imager 132
Input (translate) 141
Laser On Time 112
Linear Decode 122
Linear Security Level 112
Low Power Timeout 112
Max Gain (Imager) 133
Max Illumination (Imager) 133
Max Integration (Imager) 133
NOTIS Editing 123
Options tab 138
Output (translate) 141
Parameter Scanning 112
Postal
PlaNET 135
PostNET 136
Royal 136
Prefix 114
prefix character 117, 119
removing characters 118, 119
Scan Data Format 114
Scan Indicator 139
Scan Log File 140
Scan Result 139
Scan Result Time 139
Security Level 122
Set Length L1 116
Set Length L2 116
Suffix 114
suffix character 117, 119
Supp. Redundancy 122
Supplementals 121
target (aiming) dot duration 112, 132
Translations tab 140
Transmit Check Digit 116
Transmit Check Digit (I 2 of 5) 124
Transmit Check Digit (MSI Plessey)
125
Transmit Code 1D Char 114
Trioptic Code 39, Enable 115
UPC-A Check Digit 120
UPC-A Preamble 120
UPC-EAN 121, 134
UPC-EAN Shared Settings 130
UPC-E Check Digit 120
UPC-E Preamble 121
UPC-E1 Check Digit 120
UPC-E1 Preamble 121
2D DataMatrix 136
2D Maxicode 136
2D Micro PDF-417 126, 137
2D PDF-417 126, 137
2D QR Code 137
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
ix
Index
2D Raster Expand Rate 114
2D Raster Height 114
2D RSS Code 127, 137
2D Scanning Mode 113
2D UPC Half Block Stitching 122
Scan Result 139
Scan Result Time 139
screen
stylus, using to navigate 45
touch pen, using 45
Windows CE, navigating 45
scrolling, adjusting speed (Up_Down tab)
82
Security Level 122
security options, changing (Internet
Explorer) 192
Server Settings (modem setup) 164
service information 4
Set Length L1 116
Set Length L2 116
Settings 62, 81
Buttons 81
Personal Tab 81
Buttons icon 81
One Shot tab 82
Up_Down tab 82
SE1223 HP scanner specs 309
SE1223 HP-100A scanner, installing 268,
269
SE923 HP scanner specs 310
Shared Mode (network authentication) 75
SHIFT Key 29, 33
shutting down programs 104
single battery charger (WA3001) 289
size
of fields 117
Size/Chars (bar code scanning) 117
Sled See vehicle cradle. 298
soft keyboard (onscreen) 64
Sound, setting events 96
Sound settings 96
SPACE Key 30, 33
specifications
for WORKABOUT PRO 307
SE1223 HP scanner 309
SE923 HP scanner 310
802.11b 309
Start button 46
Start Menu 55
x
customizing 55
Start menu, customizing 94
Stop Bits 163
Storage Card tab 104
storage space, freeing (Internet Explorer)
192, 193
Strip Leading 118, 119
Strip Trailing 118, 119
stylus (touch pen), using 45
Suffix 114
Suffix Char 117, 119
Supp. Redundancy (Code 128) 122
Supplementals (UPC-EAN) 121
support services 4
swap time (for battery) 25
swivel belt loop (carrying case) 277
SX5390 2D imager specs 312
symbologies, bar code
displaying type of bar code 139
synchronizing links 196
T
TAB Key 30, 33
target dot, duration of 112, 132
task
completed (marking as) 51
creating 50
deleting 51
editing 51
sorting 51
taskbar
using 60
task notification 50
TCP_IP Settings (modem setup) 163
Terminal 163
Terminal Services Client 245
245
moving around 246
session, disconnecting (without
ending) 247
session, ending 247
tether cable 295
tether port pinout B-2
Text
Block Recognizer 65, 66
entering 63
Letter Recognizer 67
soft keyboard entry 64
transcriber, using 64
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Index
transcribing, editing within 65
title bar (navigation bar) 46
Today’s Screen (desktop screen) 45
appearance of 97
Items (to appear in screen) 98
Today’s Screen (desktop screen), navigation
bar 46
toolbar (Word), using 241
Total Recall 154
backup profile, creating 155
backup profile, restoring 157
touch pen, using 45
touchscreen
recalibration 36
stylus, using 45
touch pen, using 45
touchscreen, aligning (calibrating) 36
Transcriber
Inking 92
quick settings 92
Transcriber (Input Methods tab) 91
Transcriber, using 64
Translations parameters (bar codes) 140
Transmit Check Digit (I 2 of 5) 124
Transmit Check Digit (MSI Plessey) 125
Transmit Code 1D Char 114
trigger, double-click 138
Trioptic Code 39, Enable 115
turning WORKABOUT off 16
turning WORKABOUT on 16
U
Unicode Mapping 85
Up_Down tab (scrolling adjustments) 82
UPC A 120, 129
UPC-A Check Digit 120
UPC-A Preamble 120
UPC E 120, 129
UPC-EAN 121, 134
UPC-EAN Shared Settings 130
UPC-E Check Digit 120
UPC-E Preamble 121
UPC-E1 Check Digit 120
UPC-E1 Preamble 121
UPC Half Block Stitching, 2D 122
USB-Ethernet adaptor cable (WA4010)
288
V
vehicle adaptor 297
vehicle cradle 298
powered 10-55 VDC 298
powered 12 VDC 298
unpowered 298
vehicle cradle See also Vehicle Cradle 298
Version tab 99
videos, playing 255
View menu (Internet Explorer) 191
Volume button 47
VPN connection, setting up 166
W
wall adaptor 295
warm reset 17
warnings 139
warranty 4
web sites, organizing (Internet Explorer)
194
Windows® Start Menu 55
Windows CE, navigating in 45
Windows Media 247
media files, converting 247
media files, copying to
WORKABOUT 253
music, playing 255
music files, copying from CD to PC
251
play controls 258
syncing, automatic 253
videos, playing 255
Wireless tab 105
Wireless WAN 141–153
Word Completion tab 93
Word See Pocket Word 235
WORKABOUT PRO
approvals 308
specifications 307
worldwide offices 4, A-2
2D DataMatrix 136
2D Maxicode 136
2D Micro PDF-417 126, 137
2D PDF-417 126, 137
2D QR Code 137
2D Raster Expand Rate 114
2D Raster Height 114
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
xi
Index
2D RSS Code 127, 137
2D Scanning Mode 113
2D UPC Half Block Stitching 122
xii
Psion Teklogix WORKABOUT PRO With Windows Mobile 2003 SE User Manual
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertisement